blob: f6e1ef9d38d9519b4d49e97d3d7dd65a96190a3a [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000027#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000028#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000029#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000031#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000032#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000033#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000034#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000035#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000036#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000038#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000039#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000040#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000041#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000042#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000043
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000044using namespace clang;
45
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000046unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000048unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000050unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000052unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000054unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000056unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000059enum FloatingRank {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +000060 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000061};
62
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000063RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000064 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
66 CommentsLoaded = true;
67 }
68
69 assert(D);
70
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000071 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
72 if (D->isImplicit())
73 return NULL;
74
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000075 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
76 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
77 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
78 return NULL;
79 }
80
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000081 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
82 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
83 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
84 return NULL;
85 }
86
87 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
88 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
89 return NULL;
90 }
91
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +000092 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
93 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
94 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
95 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
96 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
97 return NULL;
98 }
99
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000100 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
101 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
102 return NULL;
103 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000104 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
105 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
106 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
107 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
108 return NULL;
109 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000110 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
111 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
112 return NULL;
113
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000114 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
115 // documentation.
116 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
117 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
118 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
119 return NULL;
120
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000121 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000122
123 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
124 if (RawComments.empty())
125 return NULL;
126
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000127 // Find declaration location.
128 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
129 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
130 // location".
131 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
132 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
133 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
134 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000135 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000136 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
137 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000138 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000139 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000140 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000141 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
142 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location
143 // as the "declaration location".
144 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID() && isa<TypedefDecl>(D))
145 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
146 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000147
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000148 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
149 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000150 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
151 return NULL;
152
153 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000154 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
155 {
156 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
157 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
158 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000159 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
160 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
161 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000162 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
163 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
164 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
165 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
166 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
167 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
168 }
169
170 if (Found) {
171 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
172 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
173 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
174 } else {
175 // Slow path.
176 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
177 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
178 }
179 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000180
181 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
182 // file buffer.
183 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
184
185 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
186 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000187 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000188 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000189 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000190 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000191 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000192 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
193 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
194 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
195 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
196 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
197 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000198 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000199 }
200 }
201
202 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
203 // Let's look at the previous comment.
204 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
205 return NULL;
206 --Comment;
207
208 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000209 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000210 return NULL;
211
212 // Decompose the end of the comment.
213 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000214 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000215
216 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
217 // aren't related.
218 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
219 return NULL;
220
221 // Get the corresponding buffer.
222 bool Invalid = false;
223 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
224 &Invalid).data();
225 if (Invalid)
226 return NULL;
227
228 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
229 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
230 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
231
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000232 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
233 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000234 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000235 return NULL;
236
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000237 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000238}
239
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000240namespace {
241/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
242/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000243/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000244const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000245 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000246 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000247 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000248 return FTD;
249
250 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
251 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
252 return D;
253
254 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
255 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
256 return FTD;
257
258 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
259 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
260 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
261 return MemberDecl;
262
263 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000264 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000265 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
266 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
267 // template?
268 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
269 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
270 return MemberDecl;
271
272 return D;
273 }
274 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
275 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
276 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
277 return CTD;
278
279 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
280 // specialization?
281 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
282 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
283 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
284 return D;
285 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
286 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
287 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
288 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
289 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
290 static_cast<const Decl*>(
291 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
292 }
293
294 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
295 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
296 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
297 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
298
299 return D;
300 }
301 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
302 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
303 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
304 return MemberDecl;
305
306 return D;
307 }
308 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000309 return D;
310}
311} // unnamed namespace
312
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000313const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
314 const Decl *D,
315 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000316 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000317
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000318 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
319 {
320 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
321 RedeclComments.find(D);
322 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
323 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000324 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
325 if (OriginalDecl)
326 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000327 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000328 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000329 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000330 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000331
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000332 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
333 const RawComment *RC = NULL;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000334 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = NULL;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000335 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000336 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000337 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000338 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
339 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
340 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
341 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000342 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000343 break;
344 }
345 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000346 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
347 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000348 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
349 if (RC) {
350 Raw.setRaw(RC);
351 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
352 } else
353 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000354 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
355 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000356 if (RC)
357 break;
358 }
359 }
360
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000361 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
362 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000363
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000364 if (OriginalDecl)
365 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
366
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000367 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
368 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
369 Raw.setRaw(RC);
370 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000371 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000372
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000373 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
374 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000375 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
376 R = Raw;
377 }
378
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000379 return RC;
380}
381
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000382static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
383 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
384 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
385 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
386 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
387 if (!ID)
388 return;
389 // Add redeclared method here.
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000390 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::known_extensions_iterator
391 Ext = ID->known_extensions_begin(),
392 ExtEnd = ID->known_extensions_end();
393 Ext != ExtEnd; ++Ext) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000394 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000395 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000396 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
397 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
398 }
399 }
400}
401
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000402comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
403 const Decl *D) const {
404 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
405 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
406 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
407 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
408 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
409 comments::FullComment *CFC =
410 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
411 ThisDeclInfo);
412 return CFC;
413
414}
415
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000416comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
417 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
418 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, 0, D) : 0;
419}
420
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000421comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
422 const Decl *D,
423 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000424 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
425 return NULL;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000426 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000427
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000428 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
429 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
430 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000431
432 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000433 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000434 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000435 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000436 return CFC;
437 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000438 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000439 }
440
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000441 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000442
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000443 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000444 if (!RC) {
445 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000446 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000447 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000448 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
449 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
450 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
451 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000452 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000453 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
454 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000455 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
456 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
457 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000458 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000459 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000460 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000461 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000462 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000463 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
464 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
465 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000466 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000467 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000468 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
469 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
470 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
471 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
472 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
473 }
474 }
475 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
476 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
477 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
478 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
479 }
480 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
481 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
482 return NULL;
483 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000484 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
485 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000486 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000487 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000488 if (Ty.isNull())
489 continue;
490 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
491 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
492 continue;
493
494 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
495 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
496 }
497 }
498 // Check virtual bases.
499 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_const_iterator I =
500 RD->vbases_begin(), E = RD->vbases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000501 if (I->getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
502 continue;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000503 QualType Ty = I->getType();
504 if (Ty.isNull())
505 continue;
506 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
507 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
508 continue;
509 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
510 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
511 }
512 }
513 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000514 return NULL;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000515 }
516
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000517 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
518 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
519 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
520 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000521 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000522 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000523
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000524 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000525 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
526 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000527}
528
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000529void
530ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
531 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
532 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
533 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000534 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000535
536 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
537 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
538 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
539 PEnd = Params->end();
540 P != PEnd; ++P) {
541 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
542 ID.AddInteger(0);
543 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
544 continue;
545 }
546
547 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
548 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000549 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000550 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000551 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
552 ID.AddBoolean(true);
553 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000554 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
555 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
556 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
557 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000558 } else
559 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000560 continue;
561 }
562
563 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
564 ID.AddInteger(2);
565 Profile(ID, TTP);
566 }
567}
568
569TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
570ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000571 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000572 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
573 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
574 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
575 void *InsertPos = 0;
576 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
577 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
578 if (Canonical)
579 return Canonical->getParam();
580
581 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
582 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000583 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000584 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
585 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
586 PEnd = Params->end();
587 P != PEnd; ++P) {
588 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
589 CanonParams.push_back(
590 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000591 SourceLocation(),
592 SourceLocation(),
593 TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000594 TTP->getIndex(), 0, false,
595 TTP->isParameterPack()));
596 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000597 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
598 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
599 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
600 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
601 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000602 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
603 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000604 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
605 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
606 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
607 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
608 }
609
610 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000611 SourceLocation(),
612 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000613 NTTP->getDepth(),
614 NTTP->getPosition(), 0,
615 T,
616 TInfo,
617 ExpandedTypes.data(),
618 ExpandedTypes.size(),
619 ExpandedTInfos.data());
620 } else {
621 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000622 SourceLocation(),
623 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000624 NTTP->getDepth(),
625 NTTP->getPosition(), 0,
626 T,
627 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
628 TInfo);
629 }
630 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
631
632 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000633 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
634 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
635 }
636
637 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
638 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
639 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000640 TTP->getPosition(),
641 TTP->isParameterPack(),
642 0,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000643 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
644 SourceLocation(),
645 CanonParams.data(),
646 CanonParams.size(),
647 SourceLocation()));
648
649 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
650 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
651 assert(Canonical == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
652 (void)Canonical;
653
654 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
655 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
656 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
657 return CanonTTP;
658}
659
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000660CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000661 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return 0;
662
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000663 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
664 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
665 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000666 return CreateARMCXXABI(*this);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +0000667 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000668 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000669 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000670 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000671 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
672 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000673 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000674}
675
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000676static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000677 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
678 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
679 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
680 // language-specific address space.
681 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
682 1, // opencl_global
683 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000684 3, // opencl_constant
685 4, // cuda_device
686 5, // cuda_constant
687 6 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000688 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000689 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000690 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000691 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000692 }
693}
694
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000695static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
696 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
697 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000698 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
699 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
700 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
701 return true;
702 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
703 return false;
704 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000705 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000706}
707
Douglas Gregor7018d5b2011-09-01 20:23:19 +0000708ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions& LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000709 const TargetInfo *t,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000710 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +0000711 Builtin::Context &builtins,
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000712 unsigned size_reserve,
713 bool DelayInitialization)
714 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()),
715 TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
716 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
717 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
718 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(0),
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000719 Int128Decl(0), UInt128Decl(0), Float128StubDecl(0),
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +0000720 BuiltinVaListDecl(0),
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +0000721 ObjCIdDecl(0), ObjCSelDecl(0), ObjCClassDecl(0), ObjCProtocolClassDecl(0),
Fariborz Jahanianf2578572012-08-30 18:49:41 +0000722 BOOLDecl(0),
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +0000723 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(0), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(0),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000724 FILEDecl(0),
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +0000725 jmp_bufDecl(0), sigjmp_bufDecl(0), ucontext_tDecl(0),
726 BlockDescriptorType(0), BlockDescriptorExtendedType(0),
727 cudaConfigureCallDecl(0),
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +0000728 NullTypeSourceInfo(QualType()),
729 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000730 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +0000731 AddrSpaceMap(0), Target(t), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000732 Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
733 BuiltinInfo(builtins),
734 DeclarationNames(*this),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +0000735 ExternalSource(0), Listener(0),
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000736 Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Dmitri Gribenkoacf2e782013-02-22 14:21:27 +0000737 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts),
Rafael Espindolace2168f2013-05-29 19:51:12 +0000738 LastSDM(0, 0)
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000739{
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000740 if (size_reserve > 0) Types.reserve(size_reserve);
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000741 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000742
743 if (!DelayInitialization) {
744 assert(t && "No target supplied for ASTContext initialization");
745 InitBuiltinTypes(*t);
746 }
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000747}
748
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000749ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000750 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
751 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
752 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000753
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000754 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
755 for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(),
756 E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I)
757 for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J)
758 (I->first)((I->second)[J]);
759
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000760 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000761 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
762 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
763 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
764 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
765 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
766 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
767 R->Destroy(*this);
768
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000769 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
770 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
771 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
772 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
773 R->Destroy(*this);
774 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000775
776 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
777 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
778 A != AEnd; ++A)
779 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000780
Reid Kleckner588c9372014-02-19 23:44:52 +0000781 llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000782}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000783
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000784void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000785 Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data);
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000786}
787
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000788void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000789ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
790 ExternalSource = Source;
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000791}
792
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000793void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000794 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
795 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000796
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000797 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000798#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000799#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
800#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
801 0 // Extra
802 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000803
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000804 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
805 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000806 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000807 }
808
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000809 unsigned Idx = 0;
810 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
811#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
812 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000813 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
814 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000815 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
816 ++Idx;
817#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
818#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000819
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000820 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
821
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000822 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000823 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
824 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
825 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
826 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
827 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
828 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000829 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000830 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
831 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
832 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
833 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
834 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
835 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000836 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000837 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
838 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
839 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
840 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
841 << NumImplicitDestructors
842 << " implicit destructors created\n";
843
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000844 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000845 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000846 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
847 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000848
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000849 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000850}
851
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000852RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
853 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000854 SourceLocation Loc;
855 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000856 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
857 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
858 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000859 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000860 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
861 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000862 NewDecl->setImplicit();
863 return NewDecl;
864}
865
866TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
867 StringRef Name) const {
868 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
869 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
870 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
871 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
872 NewDecl->setImplicit();
873 return NewDecl;
874}
875
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000876TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000877 if (!Int128Decl)
878 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000879 return Int128Decl;
880}
881
882TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000883 if (!UInt128Decl)
884 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000885 return UInt128Decl;
886}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000887
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000888TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
Nico Weber5b0b46f2013-06-21 01:29:36 +0000889 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000890 if (!Float128StubDecl)
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000891 Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000892
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000893 return Float128StubDecl;
894}
895
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000896void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000897 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000898 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000899 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000900}
901
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000902void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
903 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
904 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000905 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000906
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000907 this->Target = &Target;
908
909 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
910 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000911 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000912
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000913 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000914 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000915
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000916 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000917 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000918 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +0000919 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +0000920 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
921 else
922 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000923 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000924 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
925 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
926 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
927 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
928 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000929
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000930 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000931 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
932 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
933 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
934 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
935 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000936
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000937 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000938 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
939 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
940 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000941
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +0000942 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
943 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
944 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
945
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +0000946 // C++ 3.9.1p5
947 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
948 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
949 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
950 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
951 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
952 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
953 else {
954 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
955 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
956 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000957
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +0000958 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
959
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +0000960 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
961 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
962 else // C99
963 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
964
965 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
966 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
967 else // C99
968 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
969
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +0000970 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
971 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
972 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
973 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
974 // expressions.
975 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000976
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +0000977 // Placeholder type for functions.
978 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
979
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +0000980 // Placeholder type for bound members.
981 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
982
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +0000983 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
984 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
985
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +0000986 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
987 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
988
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +0000989 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
990 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
991
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +0000992 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
993 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
994
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000995 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +0000996 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
997 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
998 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000999
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001000 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001001 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1002 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001003 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001004
1005 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1006 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1007 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1008 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1009 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1010 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
1011 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001012
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001013 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001014 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001015 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001016
1017 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001018 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1019 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001020
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001021 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001022
1023 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001024
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001025 // void * type
1026 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001027
1028 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1029 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001030
1031 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1032 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001033
1034 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1035 VaListTagTy = QualType();
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001036}
1037
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001038DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001039 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1040}
1041
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001042AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1043 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1044 if (!Result) {
1045 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1046 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1047 }
1048
1049 return *Result;
1050}
1051
1052/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1053void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1054 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1055 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1056 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1057 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1058 }
1059}
1060
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001061// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001062MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001063ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001064 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001065 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1066 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1067}
1068
1069ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1070ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1071 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1072 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1073 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1074 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001075
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001076 return Pos->second;
1077}
1078
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001079void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001080ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001081 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1082 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001083 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1084 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001085 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1086 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1087}
1088
1089void
1090ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1091 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1092 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1093 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1094 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001095}
1096
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001097FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1098 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1099 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1100 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001101 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1102 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001103 return 0;
1104
1105 return Pos->second;
1106}
1107
1108void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1109 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1110 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1111 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001112 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001113}
1114
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001115NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001116ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001117 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001118 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1119 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001120 return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001121
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001122 return Pos->second;
1123}
1124
1125void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001126ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1127 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1128 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1129 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1130 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1131 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1132 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1133}
1134
1135UsingShadowDecl *
1136ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1137 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1138 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1139 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
1140 return 0;
1141
1142 return Pos->second;
1143}
1144
1145void
1146ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1147 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1148 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1149 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001150}
1151
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001152FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1153 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1154 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1155 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
1156 return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001157
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001158 return Pos->second;
1159}
1160
1161void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1162 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1163 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1164 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1165 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1166 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001167
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001168 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1169}
1170
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001171ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1172ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1173 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001174 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001175 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1176 return 0;
1177
1178 return Pos->second.begin();
1179}
1180
1181ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1182ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1183 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001184 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001185 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1186 return 0;
1187
1188 return Pos->second.end();
1189}
1190
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001191unsigned
1192ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1193 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001194 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001195 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1196 return 0;
1197
1198 return Pos->second.size();
1199}
1200
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001201void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1202 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001203 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001204 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1205}
1206
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001207void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1208 const NamedDecl *D,
1209 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001210 assert(D);
1211
1212 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001213 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1214 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001215 return;
1216 }
1217
1218 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1219 if (!Method)
1220 return;
1221
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001222 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1223 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001224 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001225}
1226
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001227void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1228 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1229 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1230 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1231 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1232 LastLocalImport = Import;
1233 return;
1234 }
1235
1236 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1237 LastLocalImport = Import;
1238}
1239
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001240//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1241// Type Sizing and Analysis
1242//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001243
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001244/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1245/// scalar floating point type.
1246const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001247 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001248 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1249 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001250 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001251 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001252 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1253 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1254 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001255 }
1256}
1257
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001258CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001259 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001260
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001261 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1262 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1263 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001264
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001265 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1266 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1267 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1268 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001269 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001270 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1271 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1272 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1273 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1274 } else {
1275 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1276 }
1277 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001278 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1279 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1280 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1281 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001282
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001283 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1284 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001285 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001286 // do nothing
1287
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001288 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001289 QualType T = VD->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001290 if (const ReferenceType* RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001291 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001292 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1293 else
1294 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1295 }
1296 if (!T->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001297 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1298 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001299 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001300 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1301 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001302 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1303 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1304 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1305 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1306 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1307 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001308
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001309 // Walk through any array types while we're at it.
1310 T = getBaseElementType(arrayType);
1311 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001312 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001313 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1314 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage())
1315 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1316 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001317 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001318
1319 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1320 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1321 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1322 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1323 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001324 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1325 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1326 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1327 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1328 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001329
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001330 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1331 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001332
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001333 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1334 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1335 if (Offset > 0) {
1336 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1337 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1338 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1339 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1340 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1341 }
1342
1343 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001344 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001345 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001346 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001347
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001348 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001349}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001350
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001351// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1352// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1353// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1354// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1355std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1356ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1357 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1358
1359 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1360 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1361 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1362 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1363 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1364 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1365 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1366 }
1367 }
1368
1369 return sizeAndAlign;
1370}
1371
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001372/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1373/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1374std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1375static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1376 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1377 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1378 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1379 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001380 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1381 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001382 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1383 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1384 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001385 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1386 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1387 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001388 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1389 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1390}
1391
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001392std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001393ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001394 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1395 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001396 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info = getTypeInfo(T);
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001397 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.first),
1398 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.second));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001399}
1400
1401std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001402ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001403 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1404}
1405
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001406std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
1407 TypeInfoMap::iterator it = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1408 if (it != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1409 return it->second;
1410
1411 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1412 MemoizedTypeInfo.insert(std::make_pair(T, Info));
1413 return Info;
1414}
1415
1416/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1417/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001418///
1419/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1420/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1421/// should take a QualType, &c.
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001422std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned>
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001423ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
Mike Stump5b9a3d52009-02-27 18:32:39 +00001424 uint64_t Width=0;
1425 unsigned Align=8;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001426 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001427#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1428#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001429#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001430#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001431#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1432 case Type::Class: \
1433 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1434 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001435#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001436 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001437
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001438 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1439 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001440 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1441 Width = 0;
1442 Align = 32;
1443 break;
1444
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001445 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001446 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001447 Width = 0;
1448 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1449 break;
1450
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001451 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001452 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001453
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001454 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001455 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001456 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.first <= (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
1457 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001458 Width = EltInfo.first*Size;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001459 Align = EltInfo.second;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001460 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1461 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1462 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001463 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001464 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001465 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001466 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001467 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
1468 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1469 Width = EltInfo.first*VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001470 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001471 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1472 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001473 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001474 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1475 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1476 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001477 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1478 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1479 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1480 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001481 break;
1482 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001483
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001484 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001485 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001486 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001487 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001488 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1489 Width = 0;
1490 Align = 8;
1491 break;
1492
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001493 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001494 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1495 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001496 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001497 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1498 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1499 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001500 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001501 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1502 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001503 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001504 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1505 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001506 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1507 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001508 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001509 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001510 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1511 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001512 break;
1513 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001514 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1515 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001516 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001517 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001518 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001519 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1520 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001521 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001522 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001523 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001524 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1525 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001526 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001527 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001528 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001529 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1530 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001531 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001532 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001533 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001534 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1535 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001536 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001537 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1538 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1539 Width = 128;
1540 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1541 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001542 case BuiltinType::Half:
1543 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1544 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1545 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001546 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001547 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1548 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001549 break;
1550 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001551 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1552 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001553 break;
1554 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001555 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1556 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001557 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001558 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001559 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1560 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001561 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001562 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1563 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1564 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001565 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1566 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001567 break;
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001568 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1569 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1570 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1571 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1572 break;
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001573 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001574 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1575 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1576 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1577 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1578 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1579 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1580 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1581 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1582 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1583 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001584 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001585 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001586 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001587 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1588 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001589 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001590 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001591 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1592 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001593 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1594 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001595 break;
1596 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001597 case Type::LValueReference:
1598 case Type::RValueReference: {
1599 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1600 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001601 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1602 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001603 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1604 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001605 break;
1606 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001607 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001608 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001609 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1610 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001611 break;
1612 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001613 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001614 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Benjamin Kramer867ea1d2014-03-02 13:01:17 +00001615 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001616 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001617 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001618 case Type::Complex: {
1619 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1620 // size.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001621 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo =
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001622 getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001623 Width = EltInfo.first*2;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001624 Align = EltInfo.second;
1625 break;
1626 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001627 case Type::ObjCObject:
1628 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001629 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001630 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001631 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001632 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001633 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001634 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001635 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001636 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001637 break;
1638 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001639 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001640 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001641 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1642
1643 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001644 Width = 8;
1645 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001646 break;
1647 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001648
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001649 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT))
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001650 return getTypeInfo(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType());
1651
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001652 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001653 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001654 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001655 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001656 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001657 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001658
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001659 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001660 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1661 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001662
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001663 case Type::Auto: {
1664 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001665 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1666 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001667 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001668 }
1669
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001670 case Type::Paren:
1671 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1672
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001673 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001674 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
Douglas Gregorf5bae222010-08-27 00:11:28 +00001675 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info
1676 = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001677 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1678 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1679 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
1680 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment())
1681 Align = AttrAlign;
1682 else
1683 Align = Info.second;
Douglas Gregorf5bae222010-08-27 00:11:28 +00001684 Width = Info.first;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001685 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001686 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001687
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001688 case Type::Elaborated:
1689 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001690
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001691 case Type::Attributed:
1692 return getTypeInfo(
1693 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1694
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001695 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001696 // Start with the base type information.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001697 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info
1698 = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1699 Width = Info.first;
1700 Align = Info.second;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001701
1702 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1703 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1704 // favorable to atomic operations:
1705 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1706 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1707 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1708 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1709
1710 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001711 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1712 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001713 }
1714
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001715 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001716
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001717 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001718 return std::make_pair(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001719}
1720
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001721/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1722CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1723 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1724}
1725
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001726/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1727int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1728 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1729}
1730
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001731/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1732/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001733CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001734 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001735}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001736CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001737 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001738}
1739
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001740/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001741/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001742CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001743 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001744}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001745CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001746 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001747}
1748
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001749/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1750/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1751/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1752/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001753unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001754 unsigned ABIAlign = getTypeAlign(T);
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001755
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00001756 if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore)
1757 return ABIAlign; // Never overalign on XCore.
1758
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001759 const TypedefType *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>();
1760
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001761 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00001762 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001763 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
1764 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001765 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1766 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001767 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1768 // typedef declaration.
1769 if (!TT || !TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1770 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001771
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001772 return ABIAlign;
1773}
1774
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001775/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1776/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1777unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1778 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1779}
1780
1781/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1782/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1783CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1784 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1785}
1786
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001787/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1788/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1789/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1790/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1791/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001792///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001793void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1794 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001795 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001796 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1797 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1798 if (!leafClass) {
1799 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::ivar_iterator I = OI->ivar_begin(),
1800 E = OI->ivar_end(); I != E; ++I)
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00001801 Ivars.push_back(*I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001802 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001803 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001804 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001805 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1806 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1807 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001808}
1809
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001810/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1811/// those inherited by it.
1812void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001813 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001814 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001815 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1816 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
1817 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::all_protocol_iterator P = OI->all_referenced_protocol_begin(),
1818 PE = OI->all_referenced_protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001819 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = (*P);
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001820 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001821 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = Proto->protocol_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001822 PE = Proto->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001823 Protocols.insert((*P)->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001824 CollectInheritedProtocols(*P, Protocols);
1825 }
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001826 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001827
1828 // Categories of this Interface.
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001829 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::visible_categories_iterator
1830 Cat = OI->visible_categories_begin(),
1831 CatEnd = OI->visible_categories_end();
1832 Cat != CatEnd; ++Cat) {
1833 CollectInheritedProtocols(*Cat, Protocols);
1834 }
1835
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001836 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1837 while (SD) {
1838 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1839 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1840 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001841 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001842 for (ObjCCategoryDecl::protocol_iterator P = OC->protocol_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001843 PE = OC->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
1844 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = (*P);
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001845 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001846 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = Proto->protocol_begin(),
1847 PE = Proto->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P)
1848 CollectInheritedProtocols(*P, Protocols);
1849 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001850 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001851 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = OP->protocol_begin(),
1852 PE = OP->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
1853 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = (*P);
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001854 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001855 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = Proto->protocol_begin(),
1856 PE = Proto->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P)
1857 CollectInheritedProtocols(*P, Protocols);
1858 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001859 }
1860}
1861
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001862unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001863 unsigned count = 0;
1864 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001865 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::known_extensions_iterator
1866 Ext = OI->known_extensions_begin(),
1867 ExtEnd = OI->known_extensions_end();
1868 Ext != ExtEnd; ++Ext) {
1869 count += Ext->ivar_size();
1870 }
1871
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001872 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
1873 // includes synthesized ivars.
1874 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001875 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1876
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00001877 return count;
1878}
1879
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00001880bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1881 if (!E)
1882 return false;
1883
1884 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1885 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1886
1887 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
1888 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
1889 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1890 return true;
1891
1892 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
1893 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
1894
1895 return false;
1896}
1897
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001898/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
1899ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
1900 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1901 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1902 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1903 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
1904 return 0;
1905}
1906/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
1907ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
1908 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1909 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1910 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1911 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
1912 return 0;
1913}
1914
1915/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
1916void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
1917 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
1918 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1919 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
1920}
1921/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
1922void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
1923 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
1924 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1925 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
1926}
1927
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001928const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
1929 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
1930 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
1931 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001932 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001933 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
1934 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001935 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001936 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
1937 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001938 return IMD->getClassInterface();
1939
1940 return 0;
1941}
1942
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001943/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
1944/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001945Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001946 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
1947 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1948 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001949 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001950 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001951 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : 0;
1952}
1953
1954/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
1955void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
1956 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001957 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1958 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001959 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
1960}
1961
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001962TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001963 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001964 if (!DataSize)
1965 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
1966 else
1967 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001968 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001969
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001970 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
1971 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
1972 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
1973 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00001974}
1975
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001976TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00001977 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001978 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00001979 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00001980 return DI;
1981}
1982
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001983const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001984ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001985 return getObjCLayout(D, 0);
1986}
1987
1988const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001989ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
1990 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001991 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
1992}
1993
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001994//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1995// Type creation/memoization methods
1996//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1997
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001998QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001999ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2000 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2001 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002002
2003 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2004 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002005 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
2006 void *insertPos = 0;
2007 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2008 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2009 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002010 }
2011
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002012 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2013 QualType canon;
2014 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2015 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002016 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2017 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002018
2019 // Re-find the insert position.
2020 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2021 }
2022
2023 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2024 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2025 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002026}
2027
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002028QualType
2029ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002030 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2031 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002032 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002033
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002034 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2035 // into one ExtQuals node.
2036 QualifierCollector Quals;
2037 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002038
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002039 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2040 // another one.
2041 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2042 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2043 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002044
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002045 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002046}
2047
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002048QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002049 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002050 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002051 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002052 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002053
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002054 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2055 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002056 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002057 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2058 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2059 }
2060 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002061
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002062 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2063 // into one ExtQuals node.
2064 QualifierCollector Quals;
2065 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002066
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002067 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2068 // another one.
2069 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2070 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2071 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002072
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002073 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002074}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002075
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002076const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2077 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2078 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2079 return T;
2080
2081 QualType Result;
2082 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002083 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002084 } else {
2085 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2086 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2087 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002088 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002089 }
2090
2091 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2092}
2093
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002094void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2095 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002096 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2097 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002098 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2099 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002100 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002101 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2102 FD = Next;
2103 else
2104 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002105 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002106 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2107 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002108}
2109
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002110/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2111/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002112QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002113 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2114 // structure.
2115 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2116 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002117
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002118 void *InsertPos = 0;
2119 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2120 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002121
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002122 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2123 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2124 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002125 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002126 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002127
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002128 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2129 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002130 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002131 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002132 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002133 Types.push_back(New);
2134 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2135 return QualType(New, 0);
2136}
2137
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002138/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2139/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002140QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002141 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2142 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002143 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002144 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002145
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002146 void *InsertPos = 0;
2147 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002148 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002149
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002150 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2151 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002152 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002153 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002154 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002156 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2157 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2158 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2159 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002160 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002161 Types.push_back(New);
2162 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002163 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002164}
2165
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002166QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2167 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2168 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
2169 void *InsertPos = 0;
2170 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2171 if (AT)
2172 return QualType(AT, 0);
2173
2174 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2175
2176 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2177 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2178 assert(AT == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
2179
2180 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2181 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2182 Types.push_back(AT);
2183 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2184 return QualType(AT, 0);
2185}
2186
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002187QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2188 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2189
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002190 QualType Decayed;
2191
2192 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2193 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2194 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2195 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2196 // the array type derivation.
2197 if (T->isArrayType())
2198 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2199
2200 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2201 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2202 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2203 // in 6.3.2.1.
2204 if (T->isFunctionType())
2205 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2206
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002207 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2208 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
2209 void *InsertPos = 0;
2210 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2211 if (AT)
2212 return QualType(AT, 0);
2213
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002214 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2215
2216 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002217 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2218 assert(AT == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002219
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002220 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2221 Types.push_back(AT);
2222 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2223 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002224}
2225
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002226/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002227/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002228QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002229 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2230 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002231 // structure.
2232 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2233 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002234
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002235 void *InsertPos = 0;
2236 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2237 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2238 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002239
2240 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002241 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2242 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002243 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002244 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002245
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002246 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2247 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2248 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002249 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002250 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002251 BlockPointerType *New
2252 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002253 Types.push_back(New);
2254 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2255 return QualType(New, 0);
2256}
2257
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002258/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2259/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002260QualType
2261ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002262 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2263 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2264
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002265 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2266 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002267 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002268 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002269
2270 void *InsertPos = 0;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002271 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2272 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002273 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002274
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002275 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2276
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002277 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2278 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2279 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002280 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2281 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2282 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002283
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002284 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002285 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2286 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002287 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002288 }
2289
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002290 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002291 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2292 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002293 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002294 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002295
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002296 return QualType(New, 0);
2297}
2298
2299/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2300/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002301QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002302 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2303 // structure.
2304 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002305 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002306
2307 void *InsertPos = 0;
2308 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2309 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2310 return QualType(RT, 0);
2311
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002312 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2313
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002314 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2315 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2316 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002317 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2318 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2319 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002320
2321 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2322 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2323 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002324 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002325 }
2326
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002327 RValueReferenceType *New
2328 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002329 Types.push_back(New);
2330 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002331 return QualType(New, 0);
2332}
2333
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002334/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2335/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002336QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002337 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2338 // structure.
2339 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2340 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2341
2342 void *InsertPos = 0;
2343 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2344 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2345 return QualType(PT, 0);
2346
2347 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2348 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2349 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002350 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002351 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2352
2353 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2354 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2355 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002356 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002357 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002358 MemberPointerType *New
2359 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002360 Types.push_back(New);
2361 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2362 return QualType(New, 0);
2363}
2364
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002365/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002366/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002367QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002368 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002369 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002370 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002371 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2372 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002373 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2374
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002375 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2376 // the target.
2377 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002378 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002379 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002380
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002381 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002382 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002383
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002384 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002385 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002386 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002387 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002388
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002389 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2390 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2391 QualType Canon;
2392 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2393 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002394 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002395 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002396 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002397
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002398 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002399 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002400 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002401 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002402 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002403
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002404 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002405 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002406 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002407 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002408 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002409}
2410
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002411/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2412/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2413/// sizes replaced with [*].
2414QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2415 // Vastly most common case.
2416 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002417
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002418 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002419
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002420 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002421 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002422 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2423#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2424#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2425#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2426#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2427 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2428
2429 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2430 case Type::Builtin:
2431 case Type::Complex:
2432 case Type::Vector:
2433 case Type::ExtVector:
2434 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2435 case Type::ObjCObject:
2436 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2437 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2438 case Type::Record:
2439 case Type::Enum:
2440 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2441 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2442 case Type::TypeOf:
2443 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002444 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002445 case Type::DependentName:
2446 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2447 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2448 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2449 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2450 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002451 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002452 case Type::PackExpansion:
2453 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2454
2455 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2456 // further decay.
2457 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2458 case Type::FunctionProto:
2459 case Type::BlockPointer:
2460 case Type::MemberPointer:
2461 return type;
2462
2463 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2464 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2465 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2466 // optimizations available here.
2467 case Type::Pointer:
2468 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2469 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2470 break;
2471
2472 case Type::LValueReference: {
2473 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2474 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2475 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2476 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2477 break;
2478 }
2479
2480 case Type::RValueReference: {
2481 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2482 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2483 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2484 break;
2485 }
2486
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002487 case Type::Atomic: {
2488 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2489 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2490 break;
2491 }
2492
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002493 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2494 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2495 result = getConstantArrayType(
2496 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2497 cat->getSize(),
2498 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2499 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2500 break;
2501 }
2502
2503 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2504 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2505 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2506 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2507 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2508 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2509 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2510 dat->getBracketsRange());
2511 break;
2512 }
2513
2514 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2515 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2516 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2517 result = getVariableArrayType(
2518 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
2519 /*size*/ 0,
2520 ArrayType::Normal,
2521 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2522 SourceRange());
2523 break;
2524 }
2525
2526 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2527 case Type::VariableArray: {
2528 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2529 result = getVariableArrayType(
2530 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
2531 /*size*/ 0,
2532 ArrayType::Star,
2533 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2534 vat->getBracketsRange());
2535 break;
2536 }
2537 }
2538
2539 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002540 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002541}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002542
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002543/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2544/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002545QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2546 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002547 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002548 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002549 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002550 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2551 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002552 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002553
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002554 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2555 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2556 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002557 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002558 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002559 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002560 }
2561
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002562 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002563 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002564
2565 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2566 Types.push_back(New);
2567 return QualType(New, 0);
2568}
2569
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002570/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2571/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002572/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002573QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2574 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002575 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002576 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2577 SourceRange brackets) const {
2578 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2579 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002580 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2581
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002582 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2583 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2584 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2585 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2586 if (!numElements) {
2587 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2588 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2589 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2590 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2591 brackets);
2592 Types.push_back(newType);
2593 return QualType(newType, 0);
2594 }
2595
2596 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2597 // also build a canonical type.
2598
2599 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2600
2601 void *insertPos = 0;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002602 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002603 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002604 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002605 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002606
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002607 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2608 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2609 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002610
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002611 // If we don't have one, build one.
2612 if (!canonTy) {
2613 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002614 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002615 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2616 brackets);
2617 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2618 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002619 }
2620
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002621 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2622 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002623 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002624
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002625 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type,
2626 // then just use that as our result.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002627 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002628 return canon;
2629
2630 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2631 // of the element type.
2632 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2633 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2634 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2635 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2636 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2637 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002638}
2639
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002640QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002641 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002642 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002643 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002644 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002645
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002646 void *insertPos = 0;
2647 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2648 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2649 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002650
2651 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002652 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2653 // qualifiers off the element type.
2654 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002655
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002656 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2657 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002658 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002659 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002660 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002661
2662 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002663 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2664 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2665 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002666 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002667
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002668 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2669 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002670
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002671 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2672 Types.push_back(newType);
2673 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002674}
2675
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002676/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2677/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002678QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002679 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002680 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002681
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002682 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2683 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002684 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002685
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002686 void *InsertPos = 0;
2687 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2688 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2689
2690 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2691 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2692 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002693 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002694 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002695
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002696 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2697 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002698 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002699 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002700 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002701 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002702 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2703 Types.push_back(New);
2704 return QualType(New, 0);
2705}
2706
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002707/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002708/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002709QualType
2710ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002711 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002712
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002713 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2714 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002715 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002716 VectorType::GenericVector);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002717 void *InsertPos = 0;
2718 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2719 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2720
2721 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2722 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2723 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002724 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002725 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002726
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002727 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2728 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002729 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002730 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002731 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2732 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002733 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2734 Types.push_back(New);
2735 return QualType(New, 0);
2736}
2737
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002738QualType
2739ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2740 Expr *SizeExpr,
2741 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002742 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002743 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002744 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002745
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002746 void *InsertPos = 0;
2747 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2748 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2749 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2750 if (Canon) {
2751 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2752 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002753 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2754 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2755 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002756 } else {
2757 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2758 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002759 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2760 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2761 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002762
2763 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2764 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2765 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2766 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002767 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2768 } else {
2769 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2770 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002771 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2772 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002773 }
2774 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002775
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002776 Types.push_back(New);
2777 return QualType(New, 0);
2778}
2779
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002780/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002781///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002782QualType
2783ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2784 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002785 const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC();
2786
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002787 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2788 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002789 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002790 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002791
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002792 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002793 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002794 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002795 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002796
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002797 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002798 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) {
2799 Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002800
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002801 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002802 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2803 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002804 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002805 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002806
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002807 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002808 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002809 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002810 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002811 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002812 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002813}
2814
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002815/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2816static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2817 return T.isCanonical() &&
2818 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2819 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2820}
2821
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002822QualType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002823ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002824 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002825 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2826
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002827 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2828 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002829 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002830 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
2831 *this);
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002832
2833 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002834 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002835 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002836 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002837
2838 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002839 bool isCanonical =
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002840 EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002841 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002842 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002843 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002844 isCanonical = false;
2845
2846 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002847 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002848 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002849 if (!isCanonical) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00002850 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002851 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
2852 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002853 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002854
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002855 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002856 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Sebastian Redl7c6c9e92011-03-06 10:52:04 +00002857 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpecType = EST_None;
2858 CanonicalEPI.NumExceptions = 0;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002859
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002860 // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
2861 QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
2862 if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
2863 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
2864 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
2865 CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2866 }
2867
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002868 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002869
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002870 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002871 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
2872 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002873 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002874 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002875
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002876 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
2877 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
2878 // - parameter types
2879 // - exception types
2880 // - consumed-arguments flags
2881 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002882 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
2883 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002884 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002885 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002886 if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Dynamic) {
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002887 Size += EPI.NumExceptions * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002888 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00002889 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smithf623c962012-04-17 00:58:00 +00002890 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00002891 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002892 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Unevaluated) {
2893 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002894 }
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00002895 if (EPI.ConsumedParameters)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002896 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
2897
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002898 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002899 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002900 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002901 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002902 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002903 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002904}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00002905
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002906#ifndef NDEBUG
2907static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
2908 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
2909 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
2910 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2911 return true;
2912 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
2913 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2914 return true;
2915 return false;
2916}
2917#endif
2918
2919/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
2920/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
2921QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002922 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002923 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
2924 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
2925 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002926 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002927 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
2928 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
2929 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
2930 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002931 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00002932 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002933 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2934 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002935 }
2936 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2937}
2938
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002939/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
2940/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002941QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00002942 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002943 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002944
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002945 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002946 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002947
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002948 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
2949 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
2950
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002951 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00002952 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002953 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002954 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002955 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00002956 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002957 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002958 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00002959 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002960 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
2961 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2962 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00002963 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002964 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002965
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002966 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002967}
2968
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00002969/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002970/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002971QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002972ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
2973 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002974 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002975
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002976 if (Canonical.isNull())
2977 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002978 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002979 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002980 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2981 Types.push_back(newType);
2982 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00002983}
2984
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002985QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002986 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2987
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002988 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002989 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
2990 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2991
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002992 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
2993 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2994 Types.push_back(newType);
2995 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002996}
2997
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002998QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002999 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3000
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003001 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003002 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3003 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3004
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003005 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3006 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3007 Types.push_back(newType);
3008 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003009}
3010
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003011QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3012 QualType modifiedType,
3013 QualType equivalentType) {
3014 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3015 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3016
3017 void *insertPos = 0;
3018 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3019 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3020
3021 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3022 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3023 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3024
3025 Types.push_back(type);
3026 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3027
3028 return QualType(type, 0);
3029}
3030
3031
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003032/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3033QualType
3034ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003035 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003036 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003037 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3038
3039 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3040 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
3041 void *InsertPos = 0;
3042 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3043 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3044
3045 if (!SubstParm) {
3046 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3047 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3048 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3049 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3050 }
3051
3052 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3053}
3054
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003055/// \brief Retrieve a
3056QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3057 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3058 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3059#ifndef NDEBUG
3060 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator P = ArgPack.pack_begin(),
3061 PEnd = ArgPack.pack_end();
3062 P != PEnd; ++P) {
3063 assert(P->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3064 assert(P->getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
3065 }
3066#endif
3067
3068 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3069 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
3070 void *InsertPos = 0;
3071 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3072 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3073 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3074
3075 QualType Canon;
3076 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3077 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3078 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3079 ArgPack);
3080 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3081 }
3082
3083 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3084 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3085 ArgPack);
3086 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3087 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3088 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3089}
3090
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003091/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003092/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003093/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003094QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003095 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003096 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003097 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003098 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003099 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003100 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003101 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3102
3103 if (TypeParm)
3104 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003105
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003106 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003107 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003108 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003109
3110 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3111 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3112 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3113 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003114 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003115 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3116 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003117
3118 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3119 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3120
3121 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3122}
3123
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003124TypeSourceInfo *
3125ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3126 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3127 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003128 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003129 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3130 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003131 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003132
3133 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003134 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3135 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003136 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003137 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3138 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3139 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3140 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3141 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3142 return DI;
3143}
3144
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003145QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003146ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003147 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003148 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003149 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3150 "No dependent template names here!");
3151
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003152 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3153
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003154 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003155 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3156 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3157 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3158
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003159 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003160 Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003161}
3162
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003163#ifndef NDEBUG
3164static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3165 unsigned NumArgs) {
3166 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3167 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3168 return true;
3169
3170 return true;
3171}
3172#endif
3173
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003174QualType
3175ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003176 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3177 unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003178 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003179 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3180 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003181 // Look through qualified template names.
3182 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3183 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003184
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003185 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003186 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3187 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003188 QualType CanonType;
3189 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3190 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3191 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003192 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3193 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3194 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3195 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3196 IsTypeAlias = false;
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003197 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3198 NumArgs);
3199 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003200
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003201 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3202 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3203 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003204 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3205 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003206 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003207 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003208 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003209 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3210 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003211
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003212 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003213 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003214}
3215
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003216QualType
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003217ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3218 const TemplateArgument *Args,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003219 unsigned NumArgs) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003220 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3221 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003222
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003223 // Look through qualified template names.
3224 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3225 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003226
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003227 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3228 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003229 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003230 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3231 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3232 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3233
3234 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3235 // exists.
3236 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3237 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3238 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3239
3240 void *InsertPos = 0;
3241 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3242 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3243
3244 if (!Spec) {
3245 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3246 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3247 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3248 TypeAlignment);
3249 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3250 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003251 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003252 Types.push_back(Spec);
3253 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3254 }
3255
3256 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3257 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3258 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3259}
3260
3261QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003262ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3263 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003264 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003265 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003266 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003267
3268 void *InsertPos = 0;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003269 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003270 if (T)
3271 return QualType(T, 0);
3272
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003273 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3274 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3275 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003276 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3277 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003278 (void)CheckT;
3279 }
3280
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003281 T = new (*this) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003282 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003283 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003284 return QualType(T, 0);
3285}
3286
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003287QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003288ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003289 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3290 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3291
3292 void *InsertPos = 0;
3293 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3294 if (T)
3295 return QualType(T, 0);
3296
3297 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3298 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3299 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3300 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3301 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3302 (void)CheckT;
3303 }
3304
3305 T = new (*this) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
3306 Types.push_back(T);
3307 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3308 return QualType(T, 0);
3309}
3310
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003311QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3312 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3313 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003314 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003315 assert(NNS->isDependent() && "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
3316
3317 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3318 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003319 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3320 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3321 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3322
3323 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3324 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003325 }
3326
3327 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003328 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003329
3330 void *InsertPos = 0;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003331 DependentNameType *T
3332 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003333 if (T)
3334 return QualType(T, 0);
3335
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003336 T = new (*this) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003337 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003338 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003339 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003340}
3341
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003342QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003343ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3344 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003345 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003346 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003347 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003348 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003349 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003350 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3351 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3352 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3353 ArgCopy.size(),
3354 ArgCopy.data());
3355}
3356
3357QualType
3358ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3359 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3360 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3361 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3362 unsigned NumArgs,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003363 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003364 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3365 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003366
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003367 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003368 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3369 Name, NumArgs, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003370
3371 void *InsertPos = 0;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003372 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3373 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003374 if (T)
3375 return QualType(T, 0);
3376
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003377 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003378
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003379 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3380 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3381
3382 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003383 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003384 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3385 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3386 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3387 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003388 }
3389
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003390 QualType Canon;
3391 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3392 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3393 Name, NumArgs,
3394 CanonArgs.data());
3395
3396 // Find the insert position again.
3397 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3398 }
3399
3400 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3401 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3402 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003403 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003404 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003405 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003406 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003407 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003408}
3409
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003410QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003411 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003412 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003413 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003414
3415 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3416 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
3417 void *InsertPos = 0;
3418 PackExpansionType *T
3419 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3420 if (T)
3421 return QualType(T, 0);
3422
3423 QualType Canon;
3424 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003425 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3426 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3427 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3428 // parameters.
3429 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
3430 Canon = getPackExpansionType(getCanonicalType(Pattern), NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003431
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003432 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3433 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3434 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3435 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003436 }
3437
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003438 T = new (*this) PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003439 Types.push_back(T);
3440 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3441 return QualType(T, 0);
3442}
3443
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003444/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3445/// alphabetically.
3446static bool CmpProtocolNames(const ObjCProtocolDecl *LHS,
3447 const ObjCProtocolDecl *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor77324f32008-11-17 14:58:09 +00003448 return LHS->getDeclName() < RHS->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003449}
3450
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003451static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003452 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3453 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3454
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003455 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3456 return false;
3457
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003458 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003459 if (!CmpProtocolNames(Protocols[i-1], Protocols[i]) ||
3460 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003461 return false;
3462 return true;
3463}
3464
3465static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003466 unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3467 ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003468
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003469 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
3470 std::sort(Protocols, Protocols+NumProtocols, CmpProtocolNames);
3471
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003472 // Canonicalize.
3473 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3474 Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3475
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003476 // Remove duplicates.
3477 ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3478 NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3479}
3480
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003481QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3482 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003483 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003484 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols
3485 // to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3486 if (!NumProtocols && isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(BaseType))
3487 return BaseType;
3488
3489 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003490 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003491 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003492 void *InsertPos = 0;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003493 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3494 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003495
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003496 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and
3497 // a sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003498 QualType Canonical;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003499 bool ProtocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(Protocols, NumProtocols);
3500 if (!ProtocolsSorted || !BaseType.isCanonical()) {
3501 if (!ProtocolsSorted) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003502 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> Sorted(Protocols,
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00003503 Protocols + NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003504 unsigned UniqueCount = NumProtocols;
3505
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003506 SortAndUniqueProtocols(&Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003507 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3508 &Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003509 } else {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003510 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3511 Protocols, NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003512 }
3513
3514 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003515 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3516 }
3517
3518 unsigned Size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3519 Size += NumProtocols * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3520 void *Mem = Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3521 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3522 new (Mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(Canonical, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
3523
3524 Types.push_back(T);
3525 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3526 return QualType(T, 0);
3527}
3528
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003529/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3530/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3531/// list.
3532bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3533 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3534 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3535 return false;
3536
3537 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3538 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3539 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
3540 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
3541 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = *I;
3542 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3543 return false;
3544 }
3545 return true;
3546 }
3547 return false;
3548}
3549
3550/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3551/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3552/// of protocols.
3553bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3554 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3555 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3556 return false;
3557 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3558 if (!OPT)
3559 return false;
3560 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3561 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003562 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3563 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3564 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3565 return false;
3566
3567 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator PI =
3568 InheritedProtocols.begin(),
3569 E = InheritedProtocols.end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003570 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3571 bool Adopts = false;
3572 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
3573 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
3574 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = *I;
3575 // return 'true' if '*PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
3576 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(*PI, Proto)))
3577 break;
3578 }
3579 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003580 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003581 }
3582 return true;
3583}
3584
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003585/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3586/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003587QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003588 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3589 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3590
3591 void *InsertPos = 0;
3592 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3593 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3594 return QualType(QT, 0);
3595
3596 // Find the canonical object type.
3597 QualType Canonical;
3598 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3599 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3600
3601 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003602 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3603 }
3604
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003605 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003606 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3607 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3608 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003609
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003610 Types.push_back(QType);
3611 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003612 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003613}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003614
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003615/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3616/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003617QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3618 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003619 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3620 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003621
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003622 if (PrevDecl) {
3623 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3624 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3625 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3626 }
3627
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003628 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3629 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3630 Decl = Def;
3631
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003632 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3633 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3634 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3635 Types.push_back(T);
3636 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003637}
3638
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003639/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3640/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003641/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003642/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003643/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003644QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003645 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003646 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3647 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3648 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003649
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003650 void *InsertPos = 0;
3651 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3652 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3653 if (Canon) {
3654 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3655 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003656 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003657 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003658 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003659 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003660 Canon
3661 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003662 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3663 toe = Canon;
3664 }
3665 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003666 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003667 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003668 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003669 Types.push_back(toe);
3670 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003671}
3672
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003673/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
3674/// TypeOfType AST's. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
3675/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003676/// an issue. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003677/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003678QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003679 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003680 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003681 Types.push_back(tot);
3682 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003683}
3684
Anders Carlssonad6bd352009-06-24 21:24:56 +00003685
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003686/// getDecltypeType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
3687/// DecltypeType AST's. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
3688/// memory savings. Since decltype(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003689/// an issue. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
David Blaikie876657b2011-11-06 22:28:03 +00003690/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003691QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003692 DecltypeType *dt;
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003693
3694 // C++0x [temp.type]p2:
3695 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
3696 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3697 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
3698 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003699 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3700 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003701
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003702 void *InsertPos = 0;
3703 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3704 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3705 if (Canon) {
3706 // We already have a "canonical" version of an equivalent, dependent
3707 // decltype type. Use that as our canonical type.
Richard Smithef8bf432012-08-13 20:08:14 +00003708 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType,
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003709 QualType((DecltypeType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003710 } else {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003711 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003712 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003713 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3714 dt = Canon;
3715 }
3716 } else {
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003717 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType,
3718 getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003719 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003720 Types.push_back(dt);
3721 return QualType(dt, 0);
3722}
3723
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003724/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3725/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3726QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3727 QualType UnderlyingType,
3728 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3729 const {
3730 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
Douglas Gregor6c6e6762011-05-25 17:51:54 +00003731 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3732 Kind,
3733 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
Peter Collingbourne15d48ec2012-03-05 16:02:06 +00003734 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003735 Types.push_back(Ty);
3736 return QualType(Ty, 0);
3737}
3738
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003739/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3740/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3741/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
3742QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003743 bool IsDependent) const {
3744 if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003745 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003746
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003747 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003748 void *InsertPos = 0;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003749 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003750 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003751 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3752 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003753
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00003754 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00003755 IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003756 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003757 Types.push_back(AT);
3758 if (InsertPos)
3759 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3760 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00003761}
3762
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003763/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3764/// the given value type.
3765QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3766 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3767 // structure.
3768 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3769 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3770
3771 void *InsertPos = 0;
3772 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3773 return QualType(AT, 0);
3774
3775 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3776 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3777 QualType Canonical;
3778 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3779 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3780
3781 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3782 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3783 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3784 }
3785 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
3786 Types.push_back(New);
3787 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3788 return QualType(New, 0);
3789}
3790
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003791/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
3792QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
3793 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003794 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
3795 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003796 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003797 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003798 return AutoDeductTy;
3799}
3800
3801/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
3802QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
3803 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
3804 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
3805 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
3806 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
3807}
3808
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003809/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3810/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003811QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00003812 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00003813 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
3814 // away const? mutable?
3815 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003816}
3817
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003818/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
3819/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
3820/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00003821CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003822 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00003823}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003824
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003825/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3826CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
3827 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
3828}
3829
3830/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3831CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
3832 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
3833}
3834
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00003835/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
3836/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3837QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
3838 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3839 return WCharTy;
3840}
3841
3842/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
3843/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3844QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
3845 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3846 return UnsignedIntTy;
3847}
3848
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00003849QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
3850 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
3851}
3852
3853QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
3854 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
3855}
3856
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003857/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003858/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
3859QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003860 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003861}
3862
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00003863/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
3864/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
3865QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
3866 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
3867}
3868
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00003869//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3870// Type Operators
3871//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3872
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003873CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003874 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
3875 // qualifiers.
3876 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003877 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003878 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003879 QualType Result;
3880 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
3881 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
3882 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
3883 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
3884 } else {
3885 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
3886 }
3887
3888 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
3889}
3890
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003891QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
3892 Qualifiers &quals) {
3893 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
3894
3895 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
3896 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
3897 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
3898 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
3899 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003900 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003901
3902 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003903 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003904 quals = splitType.Quals;
3905 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003906 }
3907
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003908 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
3909 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
3910 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
3911
3912 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
3913 // can just use the results in splitType.
3914 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
3915 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003916 quals = splitType.Quals;
3917 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003918 }
3919
3920 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
3921 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003922 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003923
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003924 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003925 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003926 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
3927 }
3928
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003929 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003930 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003931 }
3932
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003933 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003934 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00003935 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003936 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
3937 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3938 VAT->getBracketsRange());
3939 }
3940
3941 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003942 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003943 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
3944 SourceRange());
3945}
3946
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003947/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
3948/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
3949/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
3950/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
3951/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
3952/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
3953/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
3954/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
3955bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
3956 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
3957 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
3958 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
3959 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
3960 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
3961 return true;
3962 }
3963
3964 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
3965 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3966 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
3967 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
3968 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
3969 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
3970 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
3971 return true;
3972 }
3973
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003974 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003975 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
3976 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3977 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
3978 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
3979 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
3980 return true;
3981 }
3982 }
3983
3984 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
3985
3986 return false;
3987}
3988
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003989DeclarationNameInfo
3990ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
3991 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003992 switch (Name.getKind()) {
3993 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
3994 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003995 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003996 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
3997 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003998
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003999 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4000 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4001 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4002 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4003 }
4004
4005 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4006 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004007 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004008 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004009 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4010 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004011 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004012 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4013 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4014 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4015 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4016 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4017 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004018 }
4019 }
4020
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004021 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4022 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4023 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4024 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4025 NameLoc);
4026 }
4027
4028 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4029 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4030 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4031 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4032 NameLoc);
4033 }
4034 }
4035
4036 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004037}
4038
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004039TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004040 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4041 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4042 case TemplateName::Template: {
4043 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004044 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004045 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004046 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4047
4048 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004049 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004050 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004051
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004052 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4053 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004054
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004055 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4056 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4057 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4058 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4059 }
4060
4061 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4062 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4063 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4064 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4065 }
4066
4067 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4068 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4069 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4070 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4071 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4072 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4073 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4074 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4075 }
4076 }
4077
4078 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004079}
4080
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004081bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4082 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4083 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4084 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4085}
4086
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004087TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004088ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004089 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4090 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4091 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004092
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004093 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004094 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004095
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004096 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004097 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
4098 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.isDeclForReferenceParam());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004099 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004100
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004101 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4102 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4103 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4104
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004105 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4106 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004107
4108 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4109 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4110 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004111 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004112
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004113 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004114 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004115
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004116 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004117 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004118
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004119 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004120 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4121 return Arg;
4122
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004123 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4124 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004125 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004126 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004127 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4128 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4129 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004130
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004131 return TemplateArgument(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size());
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004132 }
4133 }
4134
4135 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004136 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004137}
4138
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004139NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004140ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004141 if (!NNS)
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004142 return 0;
4143
4144 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4145 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4146 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004147 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004148 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4149 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4150
4151 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4152 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4153 // this namespace and no prefix.
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004154 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 0,
4155 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4156
4157 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4158 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4159 // this namespace and no prefix.
4160 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 0,
4161 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4162 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004163
4164 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4165 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4166 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004167
4168 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4169 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4170 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4171 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4172 // types, e.g.,
4173 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4174 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004175 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4176 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004177 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004178
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004179 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4180 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4181 // first place?
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004182 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 0, false,
4183 const_cast<Type*>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004184 }
4185
4186 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
4187 // The global specifier is canonical and unique.
4188 return NNS;
4189 }
4190
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004191 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004192}
4193
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004194
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004195const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004196 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004197 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004198 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4199 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4200 return AT;
4201 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004202
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004203 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004204 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004205 return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004206
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004207 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004208 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4209 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004210
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004211 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4212 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004213 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004214
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004215 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004216 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004217
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004218 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004219 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004220 if (ATy == 0 || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004221 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004222
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004223 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4224 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004225 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004226
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004227 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4228 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4229 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004230 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004231 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4232 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4233 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004234 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004235
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004236 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004237 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4238 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004239 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004240 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004241 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004242 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004243 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004244
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004245 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004246 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004247 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004248 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004249 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004250 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004251}
4252
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004253QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004254 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4255 return getDecayedType(T);
4256 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004257}
4258
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004259QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004260 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4261 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4262 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4263}
4264
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004265/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4266/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4267/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4268/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4269///
4270/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004271QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004272 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4273 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4274 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4275 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4276 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4277 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004278
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004279 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004280
4281 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004282 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004283}
4284
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004285QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4286 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004287}
4288
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004289QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4290 Qualifiers qs;
4291 while (true) {
4292 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004293 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004294 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004295
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004296 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004297 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004298 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004299
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004300 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004301}
4302
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004303/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004304uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004305ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4306 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4307 do {
4308 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004309 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4310 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004311 } while (CA);
4312 return ElementCount;
4313}
4314
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004315/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4316/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004317static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004318 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004319 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004320
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004321 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4322 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004323 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004324 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004325 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4326 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4327 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004328 }
4329}
4330
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004331/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4332/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004333/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4334/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004335QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4336 QualType Domain) const {
4337 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4338 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4339 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004340 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004341 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4342 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4343 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4344 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004345 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004346
4347 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4348 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004349 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004350 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4351 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4352 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004353 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004354 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004355}
4356
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004357/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4358/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4359/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004360/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004361int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004362 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4363 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004364
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004365 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004366 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004367 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004368 return 1;
4369 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004370}
4371
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004372/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4373/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4374/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004375unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004376 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004377
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004378 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004379 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004380 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004381 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004382 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4383 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4384 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4385 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004386 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004387 case BuiltinType::Short:
4388 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004389 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004390 case BuiltinType::Int:
4391 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004392 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004393 case BuiltinType::Long:
4394 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004395 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004396 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4397 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004398 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004399 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4400 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4401 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004402 }
4403}
4404
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004405/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4406/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4407///
4408/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4409/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004410QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004411 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4412 return QualType();
4413
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004414 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004415 if (!Field)
4416 return QualType();
4417
4418 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4419
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004420 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004421 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
4422 // GCC extension compatibility: if the bit-field size is less than or equal
4423 // to the size of int, it gets promoted no matter what its type is.
4424 // For instance, unsigned long bf : 4 gets promoted to signed int.
4425 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4426 return IntTy;
4427
4428 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4429 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4430
4431 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
4432 // like the base type.
4433 // FIXME: This doesn't quite match what gcc does, but what gcc does here
4434 // is ridiculous.
4435 return QualType();
4436}
4437
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004438/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4439/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4440/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004441QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004442 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4443 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004444 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4445 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004446
4447 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4448 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4449 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4450 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4451 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4452 // unsigned long long int [...]
4453 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4454 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4455 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4456 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4457 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4458 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4459 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4460 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4461 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4462 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4463 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4464 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4465 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4466 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4467 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4468 }
4469 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4470 }
4471 }
4472
4473 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004474 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4475 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004476 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4477 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004478 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4479 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4480}
4481
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004482/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4483/// type and returns its ownership.
4484Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4485 while (!T.isNull()) {
4486 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4487 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4488 if (T->isArrayType())
4489 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4490 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4491 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4492 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004493 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004494 else
4495 break;
4496 }
4497
4498 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4499}
4500
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004501static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4502 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4503 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4504 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4505 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
4506 return NULL;
4507}
4508
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004509/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004510/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004511/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004512int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004513 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4514 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004515
4516 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4517 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4518 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4519 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4520 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4521
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004522 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004523
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004524 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4525 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004526
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004527 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4528 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004529
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004530 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4531 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4532 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4533 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004534
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004535 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4536 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4537 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4538 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4539 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004540
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004541 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4542 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004543 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004544 return -1;
4545 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004546
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004547 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4548 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4549 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004550
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004551 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4552 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004553 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004554 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004555}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004556
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004557// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004558QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004559 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004560 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("NSConstantString");
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004561 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004562
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004563 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004564
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004565 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004566 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004567 // int flags;
4568 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004569 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004570 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004571 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004572 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4573
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004574 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004575 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004576 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004577 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004578 SourceLocation(), 0,
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00004579 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004580 /*BitWidth=*/0,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004581 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004582 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004583 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004584 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004585 }
4586
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004587 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004588 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004589
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004590 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004591}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004592
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004593QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4594 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004595 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004596 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4597 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4598 }
4599 return ObjCSuperType;
4600}
4601
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004602void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004603 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004604 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4605 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4606}
4607
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004608QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004609 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4610 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4611
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004612 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004613 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004614 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4615 RD->startDefinition();
4616
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004617 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4618 UnsignedLongTy,
4619 UnsignedLongTy,
4620 };
4621
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004622 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004623 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004624 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004625 };
4626
4627 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004628 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4629 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
4630 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
4631 /*BitWidth=*/0, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004632 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004633 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004634 }
4635
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004636 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004637
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004638 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004639
4640 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4641}
4642
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004643QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004644 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4645 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4646
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004647 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004648 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004649 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
4650 RD->startDefinition();
4651
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004652 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4653 UnsignedLongTy,
4654 UnsignedLongTy,
4655 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4656 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4657 };
4658
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004659 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004660 "reserved",
4661 "Size",
4662 "CopyFuncPtr",
4663 "DestroyFuncPtr"
4664 };
4665
4666 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004667 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4668 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
4669 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
4670 /*BitWidth=*/0,
4671 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004672 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004673 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004674 }
4675
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004676 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004677
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004678 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004679 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4680}
4681
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004682/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4683/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4684/// in buildByrefHelpers.
4685bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4686 const VarDecl *D) {
4687 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4688 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4689 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4690
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004691 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00004692 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004693
4694 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4695
4696 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4697
4698 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4699 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4700 assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4701
4702 switch (lifetime) {
4703 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4704
4705 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4706 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4707 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4708 return false;
4709
4710 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4711 // byref routines.
4712 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4713 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4714 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4715 return true;
4716 }
4717 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4718 }
4719 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4720 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004721}
4722
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004723bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4724 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4725 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4726
4727 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4728 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4729 return false;
4730
4731 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00004732 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004733 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4734 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4735 }
4736 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4737 LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4738 // MRR.
4739 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4740 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4741 else
4742 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4743 return true;
4744}
4745
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004746TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4747 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00004748 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
4749 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004750 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4751}
4752
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004753// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4754// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00004755static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004756 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00004757 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
4758 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004759
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00004760 return false;
4761}
4762
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004763/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004764/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004765CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004766 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
4767 return CharUnits::Zero();
4768
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004769 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004770
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004771 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004772 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004773 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004774 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
4775 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004776 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004777 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004778}
4779
4780static inline
4781std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
4782 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004783}
4784
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004785/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004786/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004787std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
4788 std::string S;
4789
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004790 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
4791 QualType BlockTy =
4792 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4793 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004794 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004795 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
4796 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
4797 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004798 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004799 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004800 // Compute size of all parameters.
4801 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4802 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4803 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004804 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4805 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004806 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4807 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004808 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00004809 if (sz.isZero())
4810 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004811 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004812 ParmOffset += sz;
4813 }
4814 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004815 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004816 // Block pointer and offset.
4817 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004818
4819 // Argument types.
4820 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004821 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004822 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4823 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4824 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4825 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4826 // elements.
4827 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4828 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4829 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4830 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004831 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004832 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
4833 S, true /*Extended*/);
4834 else
4835 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004836 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004837 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004838 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004839
4840 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004841}
4842
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004843bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004844 std::string& S) {
4845 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004846 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004847 CharUnits ParmOffset;
4848 // Compute size of all parameters.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00004849 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4850 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004851 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004852 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004853 continue;
4854
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004855 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004856 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004857 ParmOffset += sz;
4858 }
4859 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4860 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
4861
4862 // Argument types.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00004863 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004864 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4865 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4866 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4867 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4868 // elements.
4869 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4870 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4871 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4872 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4873 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
4874 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4875 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
4876 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004877
4878 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004879}
4880
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004881/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
4882/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
4883/// block object types.
4884void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
4885 QualType T, std::string& S,
4886 bool Extended) const {
4887 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
4888 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
4889 // Encode parameter type.
4890 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, 0,
4891 true /*OutermostType*/,
4892 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
4893 false /*StructField*/,
4894 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
4895 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
4896}
4897
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004898/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004899/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004900bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004901 std::string& S,
4902 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004903 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004904 // Encode return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004905 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4906 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004907 // Compute size of all parameters.
4908 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4909 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4910 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004911 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004912 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
4913 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004914 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004915 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004916 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00004917 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004918 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004919 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004920 continue;
4921
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004922 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
4923 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004924 ParmOffset += sz;
4925 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004926 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004927 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004928 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004929
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004930 // Argument types.
4931 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004932 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004933 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004934 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004935 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00004936 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004937 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4938 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4939 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00004940 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004941 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4942 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4943 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004944 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4945 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004946 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004947 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004948 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004949
4950 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004951}
4952
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004953ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
4954ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
4955 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
4956 const Decl *Container) const {
4957 if (!Container)
4958 return 0;
4959 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
4960 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
4961 for (ObjCCategoryImplDecl::propimpl_iterator
4962 i = CID->propimpl_begin(), e = CID->propimpl_end();
4963 i != e; ++i) {
4964 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PID = *i;
4965 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
4966 return PID;
4967 }
4968 } else {
4969 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
4970 for (ObjCCategoryImplDecl::propimpl_iterator
4971 i = OID->propimpl_begin(), e = OID->propimpl_end();
4972 i != e; ++i) {
4973 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PID = *i;
4974 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
4975 return PID;
4976 }
4977 }
4978 return 0;
4979}
4980
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004981/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004982/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004983/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
4984/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004985/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
4986/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
4987/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
4988/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
4989/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004990/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
4991/// @code
4992/// enum PropertyAttributes {
4993/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
4994/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
4995/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
4996/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
4997/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
4998/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
4999/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00005000/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005001/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5002/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5003/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5004/// };
5005/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005006void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005007 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005008 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005009 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5010 bool Dynamic = false;
5011 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = 0;
5012
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005013 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5014 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5015 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5016 Dynamic = true;
5017 else
5018 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005019 }
5020
5021 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5022 S = "T";
5023
5024 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005025 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5026 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005027 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PD->getType(), S, true, true, 0,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005028 true /* outermost type */,
5029 true /* encoding for property */);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005030
5031 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5032 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005033 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5034 S += ",C";
5035 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5036 S += ",&";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005037 } else {
5038 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5039 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5040 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005041 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005042 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005043 }
5044 }
5045
5046 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5047 // are "dynamic by default".
5048 if (Dynamic)
5049 S += ",D";
5050
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005051 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5052 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005053
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005054 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5055 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005056 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005057 }
5058
5059 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5060 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005061 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005062 }
5063
5064 if (SynthesizePID) {
5065 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5066 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005067 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005068 }
5069
5070 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5071}
5072
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005073/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005074/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5075/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005076/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5077///
5078void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005079 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005080 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005081 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005082 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005083 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005084 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005085 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5086 }
5087 }
5088}
5089
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005090void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005091 const FieldDecl *Field) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005092 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5093 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5094 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5095 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005096 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahaniandaef00b2008-12-22 23:22:27 +00005097 true /* outermost type */);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005098}
5099
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005100static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5101 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5102 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005103 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5104 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5105 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5106 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005107 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005108 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005109 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005110 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5111 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005112 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005113 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5114 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5115 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5116 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5117 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005118 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5119 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005120 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5121 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005122 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005123 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5124 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5125 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5126 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005127 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005128 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5129
5130 case BuiltinType::Half:
5131 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5132 return ' ';
5133
5134 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5135 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5136 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5137 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5138
5139 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5140 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5141 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5142 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5143 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5144 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5145 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005146 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005147 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005148 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5149#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5150#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5151 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5152#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5153 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005154 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005155 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005156}
5157
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005158static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5159 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5160
5161 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5162 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5163 return 'i';
5164
5165 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005166 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5167 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005168}
5169
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005170static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005171 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005172 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005173 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005174 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5175 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5176 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5177 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5178 //
5179 // struct
5180 // {
5181 // int integer;
5182 // int flags:2;
5183 // };
5184 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5185 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5186 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5187 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5188 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005189 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005190 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5191 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005192 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005193 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5194 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005195 else {
5196 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5197 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5198 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005199 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005200 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005201}
5202
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005203// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005204void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5205 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5206 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005207 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005208 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005209 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005210 bool StructField,
5211 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005212 bool EncodeClassNames,
5213 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005214 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5215 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5216 case Type::Builtin:
5217 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005218 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005219 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005220 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5221 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5222 else
5223 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005224 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005225
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005226 case Type::Complex: {
5227 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005228 S += 'j';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005229 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, 0, false,
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005230 false);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005231 return;
5232 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005233
5234 case Type::Atomic: {
5235 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5236 S += 'A';
5237 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, 0,
5238 false, false);
5239 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005240 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005241
5242 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5243 case Type::Pointer:
5244 case Type::LValueReference:
5245 case Type::RValueReference: {
5246 QualType PointeeTy;
5247 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5248 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5249 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5250 S += ':';
5251 return;
5252 }
5253 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5254 } else {
5255 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5256 }
5257
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005258 bool isReadOnly = false;
5259 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5260 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5261 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005262 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005263 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005264 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5265 isReadOnly = true;
5266 S += 'r';
5267 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005268 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005269 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005270 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5271 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005272 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5273 isReadOnly = true;
5274 S += 'r';
5275 }
5276 }
5277 if (isReadOnly) {
5278 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5279 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5280 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005281 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005282 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005283 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005284
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005285 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5286 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5287 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005288 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005289 S += '*';
5290 return;
5291 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005292 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005293 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5294 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5295 S += '#';
5296 return;
5297 }
5298 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5299 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5300 S += '@';
5301 return;
5302 }
5303 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005304 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005305 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005306 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5307
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005308 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005309 NULL);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005310 return;
5311 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005312
5313 case Type::ConstantArray:
5314 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5315 case Type::VariableArray: {
5316 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5317
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005318 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005319 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5320 S += '^';
5321
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005322 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005323 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5324 } else {
5325 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005326
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00005327 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5328 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5329 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005330 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005331 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5332 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005333 S += '0';
5334 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005335
5336 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005337 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5338 S += ']';
5339 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005340 return;
5341 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005342
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005343 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5344 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005345 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005346 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005347
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005348 case Type::Record: {
5349 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005350 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005351 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5352 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5353 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005354 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5355 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5356 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005357 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5358 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005359 TemplateArgs.data(),
5360 TemplateArgs.size(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005361 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005362 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005363 } else {
5364 S += '?';
5365 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005366 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005367 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005368 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
5369 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD);
5370 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005371 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005372 if (FD) {
5373 S += '"';
5374 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5375 S += '"';
5376 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005377
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005378 // Special case bit-fields.
5379 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5380 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005381 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005382 } else {
5383 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5384 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5385 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5386 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5387 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5388 /*StructField*/true);
5389 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005390 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005391 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005392 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005393 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005394 return;
5395 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005396
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005397 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5398 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005399 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005400 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005401 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005402
5403 S += '<';
5404 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005405 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5406 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5407 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5408 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005409 // Block self
5410 S += "@?";
5411 // Block parameters
5412 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00005413 for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator I = FPT->param_type_begin(),
5414 E = FPT->param_type_end();
5415 I && (I != E); ++I) {
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005416 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(*I, S,
5417 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5418 ExpandStructures,
5419 FD,
5420 false /* OutermostType */,
5421 EncodingProperty,
5422 false /* StructField */,
5423 EncodeBlockParameters,
5424 EncodeClassNames);
5425 }
5426 }
5427 S += '>';
5428 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005429 return;
5430 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005431
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00005432 case Type::ObjCObject: {
5433 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5434 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5435 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5436 S += "{objc_object=}";
5437 return;
5438 }
5439 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5440 S += "{objc_class=}";
5441 return;
5442 }
5443 }
5444
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005445 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5446 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5447 T = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getBaseType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005448
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005449 // The assumption seems to be that this assert will succeed
5450 // because nested levels will have filtered out 'id' and 'Class'.
5451 const ObjCInterfaceType *OIT = T->castAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005452 // @encode(class_name)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005453 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OIT->getDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005454 S += '{';
5455 const IdentifierInfo *II = OI->getIdentifier();
5456 S += II->getName();
5457 S += '=';
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005458 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005459 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5460 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005461 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005462 if (Field->isBitField())
5463 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005464 else
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005465 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5466 false, false, false, false, false,
5467 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005468 }
5469 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005470 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005471 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005472
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005473 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5474 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005475 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5476 S += '@';
5477 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005478 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005479
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005480 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5481 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5482 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5483 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005484 S += '#';
5485 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005486 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005487
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005488 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005489 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005490 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5491 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005492 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005493 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5494 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005495 S += '"';
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005496 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
5497 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005498 S += '<';
5499 S += (*I)->getNameAsString();
5500 S += '>';
5501 }
5502 S += '"';
5503 }
5504 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005505 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005506
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005507 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5508 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005509 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5510 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005511 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005512 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005513 // {...};
5514 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005515 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00005516 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005517 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5518 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5519 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5520 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5521 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5522 S += '{';
5523 S += OI->getIdentifier()->getName();
5524 S += '}';
5525 return;
5526 }
5527 }
5528 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005529 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5530 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005531 NULL,
5532 false, false, false, false, false,
5533 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005534 return;
5535 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005536
5537 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005538 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5539 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005540 S += '"';
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005541 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getIdentifier()->getName();
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005542 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
5543 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005544 S += '<';
5545 S += (*I)->getNameAsString();
5546 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005547 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005548 S += '"';
5549 }
5550 return;
5551 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005552
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005553 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005554 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5555 case Type::MemberPointer:
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005556 return;
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005557
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005558 case Type::Vector:
5559 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005560 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is
5561 // insufficient.
5562 // FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
5563 return;
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005564
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005565 case Type::Auto:
5566 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5567 // Just ignore it.
5568 return;
5569
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005570#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5571#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5572#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5573 case Type::KIND:
5574#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5575 case Type::KIND:
5576#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5577 case Type::KIND:
5578#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5579 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005580 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005581 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005582}
5583
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005584void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5585 std::string &S,
5586 const FieldDecl *FD,
5587 bool includeVBases) const {
5588 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5589 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5590 if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5591 return;
5592
5593 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5594 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5595 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5596
5597 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00005598 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5599 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5600 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005601 if (base->isEmpty())
5602 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005603 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005604 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5605 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5606 }
5607 }
5608 }
5609
5610 unsigned i = 0;
5611 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator Field = RDecl->field_begin(),
5612 FieldEnd = RDecl->field_end();
5613 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field, ++i) {
5614 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5615 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005616 std::make_pair(offs, *Field));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005617 }
5618
5619 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
5620 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator
5621 BI = CXXRec->vbases_begin(),
5622 BE = CXXRec->vbases_end(); BI != BE; ++BI) {
5623 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005624 if (base->isEmpty())
5625 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005626 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00005627 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5628 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00005629 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5630 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005631 }
5632 }
5633
5634 CharUnits size;
5635 if (CXXRec) {
5636 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5637 } else {
5638 size = layout.getSize();
5639 }
5640
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005641#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005642 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005643#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005644 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5645 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5646
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00005647 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5648 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005649 if (FD) {
5650 S += "\"_vptr$";
5651 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5652 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5653 S += recname;
5654 S += '"';
5655 }
5656 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005657#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005658 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005659#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005660 }
5661
5662 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5663 // Mark the end of the structure.
5664 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5665 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5666 std::make_pair(offs, (NamedDecl*)0));
5667 }
5668
5669 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005670#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005671 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005672 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5673 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5674 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5675 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5676 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5677 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5678 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5679 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5680 // longer then though.
5681 CurOffs += padding;
5682 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005683#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005684
5685 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
5686 if (dcl == 0)
5687 break; // reached end of structure.
5688
5689 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5690 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5691 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5692 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5693 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
5694 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005695 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005696#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005697 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005698#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005699 } else {
5700 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5701 if (FD) {
5702 S += '"';
5703 S += field->getNameAsString();
5704 S += '"';
5705 }
5706
5707 if (field->isBitField()) {
5708 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005709#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005710 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005711#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005712 } else {
5713 QualType qt = field->getType();
5714 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5715 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5716 /*OutermostType*/false,
5717 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5718 /*StructField*/true);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005719#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005720 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005721#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005722 }
5723 }
5724 }
5725}
5726
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005727void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00005728 std::string& S) const {
5729 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5730 S += 'n';
5731 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5732 S += 'N';
5733 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5734 S += 'o';
5735 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5736 S += 'O';
5737 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5738 S += 'R';
5739 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5740 S += 'V';
5741}
5742
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005743TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
5744 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
5745 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, 0, 0);
5746 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005747 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005748 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005749 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00005750}
5751
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005752TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
5753 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005754 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
5755 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005756 }
5757 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00005758}
5759
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005760TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
5761 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
5762 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, 0, 0);
5763 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005764 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005765 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005766 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00005767}
5768
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005769ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
5770 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
5771 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
5772 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5773 SourceLocation(),
5774 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
5775 /*PrevDecl=*/0,
5776 SourceLocation(), true);
5777 }
5778
5779 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
5780}
5781
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005782//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5783// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
5784//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5785
5786static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5787 // typedef char* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005788 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
5789 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005790}
5791
5792static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5793 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005794 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5795 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005796}
5797
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005798static TypedefDecl *
5799CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005800 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005801 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005802 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5803 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5804 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5805 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5806 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5807 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
5808 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
5809 /*PrevDecl*/0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005810 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005811 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005812 }
5813
5814 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5815
5816 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5817 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5818 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5819
5820 // void *__stack;
5821 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5822 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
5823
5824 // void *__gr_top;
5825 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5826 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
5827
5828 // void *__vr_top;
5829 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5830 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
5831
5832 // int __gr_offs;
5833 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
5834 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
5835
5836 // int __vr_offs;
5837 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
5838 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
5839
5840 // Create fields
5841 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5842 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5843 VaListTagDecl,
5844 SourceLocation(),
5845 SourceLocation(),
5846 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
5847 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
5848 /*BitWidth=*/0,
5849 /*Mutable=*/false,
5850 ICIS_NoInit);
5851 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5852 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5853 }
5854 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5855 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
5856 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
5857
5858 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005859 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005860}
5861
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005862static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5863 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5864 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5865
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005866 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005867 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5868
5869 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5870 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5871 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5872
5873 // unsigned char gpr;
5874 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5875 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
5876
5877 // unsigned char fpr;
5878 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5879 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
5880
5881 // unsigned short reserved;
5882 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
5883 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
5884
5885 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5886 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5887 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
5888
5889 // void* reg_save_area;
5890 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5891 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
5892
5893 // Create fields
5894 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5895 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
5896 SourceLocation(),
5897 SourceLocation(),
5898 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
5899 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
5900 /*BitWidth=*/0,
5901 /*Mutable=*/false,
5902 ICIS_NoInit);
5903 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5904 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5905 }
5906 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5907 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005908 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005909
5910 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005911 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
5912 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
5913
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005914 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5915 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5916
5917 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5918 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5919 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5920 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5921 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005922 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005923}
5924
5925static TypedefDecl *
5926CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5927 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5928 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005929 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005930 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5931
5932 const size_t NumFields = 4;
5933 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5934 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5935
5936 // unsigned gp_offset;
5937 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5938 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
5939
5940 // unsigned fp_offset;
5941 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5942 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
5943
5944 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5945 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5946 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
5947
5948 // void* reg_save_area;
5949 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5950 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
5951
5952 // Create fields
5953 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5954 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5955 VaListTagDecl,
5956 SourceLocation(),
5957 SourceLocation(),
5958 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
5959 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
5960 /*BitWidth=*/0,
5961 /*Mutable=*/false,
5962 ICIS_NoInit);
5963 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5964 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5965 }
5966 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5967 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005968 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005969
5970 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005971 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
5972 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
5973
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005974 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5975 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5976
5977 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5978 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5979 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5980 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5981 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005982 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005983}
5984
5985static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5986 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
5987 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
5988 QualType IntArrayType
5989 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
5990 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005991 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005992}
5993
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00005994static TypedefDecl *
5995CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005996 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005997 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00005998 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5999 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6000 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6001 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6002 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6003 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6004 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
6005 /*PrevDecl*/0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006006 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006007 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006008 }
6009
6010 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6011
6012 // void * __ap;
6013 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6014 VaListDecl,
6015 SourceLocation(),
6016 SourceLocation(),
6017 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6018 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
6019 /*TInfo=*/0,
6020 /*BitWidth=*/0,
6021 /*Mutable=*/false,
6022 ICIS_NoInit);
6023 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6024 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6025
6026 // };
6027 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6028
6029 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006030 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6031 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006032}
6033
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006034static TypedefDecl *
6035CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6036 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6037 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006038 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006039 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6040
6041 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6042 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6043 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6044
6045 // long __gpr;
6046 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6047 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6048
6049 // long __fpr;
6050 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6051 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6052
6053 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6054 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6055 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6056
6057 // void *__reg_save_area;
6058 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6059 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6060
6061 // Create fields
6062 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6063 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6064 VaListTagDecl,
6065 SourceLocation(),
6066 SourceLocation(),
6067 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6068 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
6069 /*BitWidth=*/0,
6070 /*Mutable=*/false,
6071 ICIS_NoInit);
6072 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6073 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6074 }
6075 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6076 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6077 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6078
6079 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006080 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6081 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006082 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6083 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6084
6085 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6086 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6087 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6088 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6089 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006090
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006091 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006092}
6093
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006094static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6095 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6096 switch (Kind) {
6097 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6098 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6099 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6100 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006101 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6102 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006103 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6104 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6105 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6106 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6107 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6108 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006109 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6110 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006111 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6112 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006113 }
6114
6115 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6116}
6117
6118TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006119 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006120 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006121 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6122 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006123
6124 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6125}
6126
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006127QualType ASTContext::getVaListTagType() const {
6128 // Force the creation of VaListTagTy by building the __builtin_va_list
6129 // declaration.
6130 if (VaListTagTy.isNull())
6131 (void) getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6132
6133 return VaListTagTy;
6134}
6135
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006136void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006137 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006138 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006139
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006140 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006141}
6142
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006143/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6144/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006145TemplateName
6146ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6147 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006148 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6149 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6150
6151 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6152 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6153 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6154
6155 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006156 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006157 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6158 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6159 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6160 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6161 *Storage++ = D;
6162 }
6163
6164 return TemplateName(OT);
6165}
6166
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006167/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6168/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006169TemplateName
6170ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6171 bool TemplateKeyword,
6172 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006173 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6174
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006175 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006176 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6177 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6178
6179 void *InsertPos = 0;
6180 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6181 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6182 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006183 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6184 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006185 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6186 }
6187
6188 return TemplateName(QTN);
6189}
6190
6191/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6192/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006193TemplateName
6194ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6195 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006196 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006197 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006198
6199 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6200 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6201
6202 void *InsertPos = 0;
6203 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6204 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6205
6206 if (QTN)
6207 return TemplateName(QTN);
6208
6209 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6210 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006211 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6212 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006213 } else {
6214 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006215 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6216 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006217 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6218 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6219 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6220 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006221 }
6222
6223 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6224 return TemplateName(QTN);
6225}
6226
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006227/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6228/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6229TemplateName
6230ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006231 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006232 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6233 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6234
6235 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6236 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
6237
6238 void *InsertPos = 0;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006239 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6240 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006241
6242 if (QTN)
6243 return TemplateName(QTN);
6244
6245 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6246 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006247 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6248 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006249 } else {
6250 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006251 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6252 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006253
6254 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6255 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6256 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6257 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006258 }
6259
6260 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6261 return TemplateName(QTN);
6262}
6263
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006264TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006265ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6266 TemplateName replacement) const {
6267 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6268 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
6269
6270 void *insertPos = 0;
6271 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6272 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6273
6274 if (!subst) {
6275 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6276 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6277 }
6278
6279 return TemplateName(subst);
6280}
6281
6282TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006283ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6284 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6285 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6286 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6287 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
6288
6289 void *InsertPos = 0;
6290 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6291 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6292
6293 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006294 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006295 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6296 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6297 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6298 }
6299
6300 return TemplateName(Subst);
6301}
6302
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006303/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006304/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6305/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006306CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006307 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006308 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00006309 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6310 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006311 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6312 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6313 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6314 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6315 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6316 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6317 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6318 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6319 }
6320
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006321 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006322}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006323
6324//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6325// Type Predicates.
6326//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6327
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006328/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6329/// garbage collection attribute.
6330///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006331Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006332 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006333 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6334
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006335 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006336 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6337
6338 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6339 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6340 // as __strong.
6341 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6342 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6343 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6344 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6345 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6346 } else {
6347 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6348 // pointer.
6349#ifndef NDEBUG
6350 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6351 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6352 CT = AT->getElementType();
6353 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6354#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006355 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006356 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006357}
6358
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006359//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6360// Type Compatibility Testing
6361//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006362
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006363/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006364/// compatible.
6365static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6366 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006367 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006368 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006369 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006370}
6371
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006372bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6373 QualType SecondVec) {
6374 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6375 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6376
6377 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6378 return true;
6379
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006380 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6381 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006382 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6383 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006384 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006385 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006386 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6387 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6388 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6389 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006390 return true;
6391
6392 return false;
6393}
6394
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006395//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6396// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6397//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6398
6399/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6400/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006401bool
6402ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6403 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006404 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006405 return true;
6406 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator PI = rProto->protocol_begin(),
6407 E = rProto->protocol_end(); PI != E; ++PI)
6408 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, *PI))
6409 return true;
6410 return false;
6411}
6412
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006413/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6414/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006415bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6416 QualType rhs) {
6417 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6418 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6419 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6420
6421 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6422 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6423 bool match = false;
6424 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = *I;
6425 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsOPT->qual_begin(),
6426 E = rhsOPT->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6427 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6428 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6429 match = true;
6430 break;
6431 }
6432 }
6433 if (!match)
6434 return false;
6435 }
6436 return true;
6437}
6438
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006439/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6440/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6441bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6442 bool compare) {
6443 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006444 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006445 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6446 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006447 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006448 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6449 return true;
6450
6451 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006452 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006453
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006454 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006455
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006456 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006457 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006458 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6459 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6460 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6461 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6462 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6463 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6464 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanian3f8917a2009-08-11 22:02:25 +00006465 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(*I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006466 return false;
6467 }
6468 }
6469 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6470 return true;
6471 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006472 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006473 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6474 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6475 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = *I;
6476 bool match = false;
6477
6478 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6479 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6480 // through its super class and categories.
6481 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsOPT->qual_begin(),
6482 E = rhsOPT->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6483 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6484 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6485 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6486 match = true;
6487 break;
6488 }
6489 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006490 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006491 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6492 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6493 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6494 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6495 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6496 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6497 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanian3f8917a2009-08-11 22:02:25 +00006498 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(*I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006499 match = true;
6500 break;
6501 }
6502 }
6503 }
6504 if (!match)
6505 return false;
6506 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006507
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006508 return true;
6509 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006510
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006511 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6512 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6513
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006514 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006515 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006516 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006517 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsOPT->qual_begin(),
6518 E = lhsOPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6519 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = *I;
6520 bool match = false;
6521
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006522 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006523 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6524 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006525 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6526 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006527 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsQID->qual_begin(),
6528 E = rhsQID->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6529 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6530 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6531 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6532 match = true;
6533 break;
6534 }
6535 }
6536 if (!match)
6537 return false;
6538 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006539
6540 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6541 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6542 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6543 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6544 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6545 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6546 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6547 // assume that it is mismatch.
6548 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6549 return false;
6550 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6551 LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6552 E = LHSInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6553 bool match = false;
6554 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = (*I);
6555 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsQID->qual_begin(),
6556 E = rhsQID->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6557 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6558 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6559 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6560 match = true;
6561 break;
6562 }
6563 }
6564 if (!match)
6565 return false;
6566 }
6567 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006568 return true;
6569 }
6570 return false;
6571}
6572
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006573/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006574/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6575/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6576///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006577bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6578 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006579 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6580 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6581
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006582 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006583 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6584 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006585 return true;
6586
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006587 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006588 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6589 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006590 false);
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006591
6592 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass())
6593 return ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6594 QualType(RHSOPT,0));
6595
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006596 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6597 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface())
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006598 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006599
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006600 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006601}
6602
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006603/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006604/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006605/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6606/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6607/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6608bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6609 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006610 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6611 bool BlockReturnType) {
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006612 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006613 return true;
6614
6615 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6616 return RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType();
6617 }
6618
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006619 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006620 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6621 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6622 false);
6623
6624 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6625 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6626 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6627 if (LHS != RHS) {
6628 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006629 return BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006630 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006631 return !BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006632 }
6633 else
6634 return true;
6635 }
6636 return false;
6637}
6638
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006639/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6640/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects.
6641/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6642/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6643static
6644void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6645 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6646 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006647 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionOfProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006648
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006649 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6650 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6651 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6652 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006653
6654 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocolSet;
6655 unsigned LHSNumProtocols = LHS->getNumProtocols();
6656 if (LHSNumProtocols > 0)
6657 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHS->qual_begin(), LHS->qual_end());
6658 else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006659 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006660 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(),
6661 LHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006662 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6663 LHSInheritedProtocols.end());
6664 }
6665
6666 unsigned RHSNumProtocols = RHS->getNumProtocols();
6667 if (RHSNumProtocols > 0) {
Dan Gohman145f3f12010-04-19 16:39:44 +00006668 ObjCProtocolDecl **RHSProtocols =
6669 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl **>(RHS->qual_begin());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006670 for (unsigned i = 0; i < RHSNumProtocols; ++i)
6671 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(RHSProtocols[i]))
6672 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(RHSProtocols[i]);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00006673 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006674 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006675 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(),
6676 RHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006677 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6678 RHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6679 E = RHSInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I)
6680 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count((*I)))
6681 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back((*I));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006682 }
6683}
6684
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006685/// areCommonBaseCompatible - Returns common base class of the two classes if
6686/// one found. Note that this is O'2 algorithm. But it will be called as the
6687/// last type comparison in a ?-exp of ObjC pointer types before a
6688/// warning is issued. So, its invokation is extremely rare.
6689QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006690 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
6691 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
6692 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
6693 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
6694 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
6695 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregor0b144e12011-12-15 00:29:59 +00006696 if (!LDecl || !RDecl || (declaresSameEntity(LDecl, RDecl)))
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006697 return QualType();
6698
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006699 do {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006700 LHS = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(getObjCInterfaceType(LDecl));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006701 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006702 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006703 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, Lptr, Rptr, Protocols);
6704
6705 QualType Result = QualType(LHS, 0);
6706 if (!Protocols.empty())
6707 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, Protocols.data(), Protocols.size());
6708 Result = getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
6709 return Result;
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006710 }
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006711 } while ((LDecl = LDecl->getSuperClass()));
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006712
6713 return QualType();
6714}
6715
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006716bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
6717 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
6718 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
6719 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
6720
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006721 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
6722 // the LHS.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006723 if (!LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()))
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006724 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006725
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006726 // RHS must have a superset of the protocols in the LHS. If the LHS is not
6727 // protocol qualified at all, then we are good.
Steve Naroffc277ad12009-07-18 15:33:26 +00006728 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() == 0)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006729 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006730
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006731 // Okay, we know the LHS has protocol qualifiers. If the RHS doesn't,
6732 // more detailed analysis is required.
6733 if (RHS->getNumProtocols() == 0) {
6734 // OK, if LHS is a superclass of RHS *and*
6735 // this superclass is assignment compatible with LHS.
6736 // false otherwise.
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006737 bool IsSuperClass =
6738 LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
6739 if (IsSuperClass) {
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006740 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
6741 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
6742 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
6743 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
6744 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006745 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006746 // If super class has no protocols, it is not a match.
6747 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
6748 return false;
6749
6750 for (ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator LHSPI = LHS->qual_begin(),
6751 LHSPE = LHS->qual_end();
6752 LHSPI != LHSPE; LHSPI++) {
6753 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
6754 ObjCProtocolDecl *LHSProto = (*LHSPI);
6755
6756 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6757 SuperClassInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6758 E = SuperClassInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6759 ObjCProtocolDecl *SuperClassProto = (*I);
6760 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
6761 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
6762 break;
6763 }
6764 }
6765 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
6766 return false;
6767 }
6768 return true;
6769 }
6770 return false;
6771 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006772
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006773 for (ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator LHSPI = LHS->qual_begin(),
6774 LHSPE = LHS->qual_end();
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006775 LHSPI != LHSPE; LHSPI++) {
6776 bool RHSImplementsProtocol = false;
6777
6778 // If the RHS doesn't implement the protocol on the left, the types
6779 // are incompatible.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006780 for (ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator RHSPI = RHS->qual_begin(),
6781 RHSPE = RHS->qual_end();
Steve Narofffac5bc92009-07-16 16:21:02 +00006782 RHSPI != RHSPE; RHSPI++) {
6783 if ((*RHSPI)->lookupProtocolNamed((*LHSPI)->getIdentifier())) {
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006784 RHSImplementsProtocol = true;
Steve Narofffac5bc92009-07-16 16:21:02 +00006785 break;
6786 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006787 }
6788 // FIXME: For better diagnostics, consider passing back the protocol name.
6789 if (!RHSImplementsProtocol)
6790 return false;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006791 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006792 // The RHS implements all protocols listed on the LHS.
6793 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006794}
6795
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006796bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6797 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006798 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6799 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006800
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006801 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006802 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006803
6804 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
6805 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006806}
6807
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00006808bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
6809 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
6810 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
6811 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
6812}
6813
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006814/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006815/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006816/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006817/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006818bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
6819 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006820 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00006821 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
6822
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006823 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006824}
6825
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006826bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00006827 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006828}
6829
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006830bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6831 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
6832}
6833
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006834/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
6835/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
6836/// QualType()
6837QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
6838 bool OfBlockPointer,
6839 bool Unqualified) {
6840 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
6841 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
6842 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006843 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
6844 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006845 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6846 if (!MT.isNull())
6847 return MT;
6848 }
6849 }
6850 }
6851
6852 return QualType();
6853}
6854
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006855/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
6856/// parameter types
6857QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6858 bool OfBlockPointer,
6859 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006860 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
6861 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
6862 // type is compatible with a union member
6863 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
6864 Unqualified);
6865 if (!lmerge.isNull())
6866 return lmerge;
6867
6868 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
6869 Unqualified);
6870 if (!rmerge.isNull())
6871 return rmerge;
6872
6873 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6874}
6875
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006876QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006877 bool OfBlockPointer,
6878 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006879 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
6880 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006881 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
6882 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006883 bool allLTypes = true;
6884 bool allRTypes = true;
6885
6886 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006887 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006888 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006889 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
6890 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006891 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
6892 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
6893 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006894 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006895 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006896 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006897 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006898 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006899 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006900
6901 if (Unqualified)
6902 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
6903
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006904 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
6905 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006906 if (Unqualified) {
6907 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6908 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6909 }
6910
6911 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006912 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006913 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006914 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006915
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00006916 // FIXME: double check this
6917 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6918 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6919 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006920 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
6921 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006922
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006923 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00006924 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006925 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006926
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006927 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00006928 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
6929 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006930 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
6931 return QualType();
6932
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006933 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
6934 return QualType();
6935
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006936 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
6937 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006938
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00006939 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6940 allLTypes = false;
6941 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6942 allRTypes = false;
6943
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006944 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006945
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006946 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006947 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
6948 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006949 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
6950 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006951 return QualType();
6952
6953 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
6954 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
6955 return QualType();
6956
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00006957 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
6958 return QualType();
6959
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006960 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6961 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
6962 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006963
6964 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006965 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006966 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
6967 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
6968 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
6969 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
6970 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6971 if (paramType.isNull())
6972 return QualType();
6973
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006974 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006975 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
6976
6977 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006978 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006979 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
6980 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006981 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006982
6983 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006984 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006985 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006986 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006987 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006988
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006989 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
6990 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006991
6992 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
6993 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00006994 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006995 }
6996
6997 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
6998 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
6999
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007000 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007001 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007002 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007003 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7004 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7005 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7006 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7007 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7008 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007009 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
7010 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007011
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007012 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007013 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007014 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7015 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7016 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007017 return QualType();
7018 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007019
7020 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7021 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007022 return QualType();
7023 }
7024
7025 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7026 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007027
7028 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7029 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007030 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007031 }
7032
7033 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7034 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007035 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007036}
7037
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007038/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7039static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7040 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7041 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7042 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7043 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7044 // type.
7045 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7046 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7047 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7048 return other;
7049
7050 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7051 // integral type of the same size.
7052 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7053 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7054 return other;
7055
7056 return QualType();
7057}
7058
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007059QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007060 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007061 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007062 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7063 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7064 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007065 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7066 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007067 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7068 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007069
7070 if (Unqualified) {
7071 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7072 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7073 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007074
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007075 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7076 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7077
7078 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7079 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7080 return LHS;
7081
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007082 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007083 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7084 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007085 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7086 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7087 // mismatch.
7088 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007089 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7090 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007091 return QualType();
7092
7093 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7094 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7095 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7096 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7097 // qualified __strong.
7098 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7099 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7100 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7101
7102 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7103 return QualType();
7104
7105 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7106 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7107 }
7108 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7109 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7110 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007111 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007112 }
7113
7114 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007115
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007116 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7117 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007118
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007119 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7120 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7121 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7122 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007123
7124 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007125 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7126 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7127 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7128 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007129
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007130 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7131 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7132 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7133
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007134 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7135 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7136 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007137
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007138 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007139 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007140 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7141 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007142 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007143 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007144 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007145 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007146 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007147 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007148 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007149 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7150 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7151 return LHS;
7152 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7153 return RHS;
7154 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007155
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007156 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007157 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007158
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007159 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007160 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007161#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7162#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007163#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007164#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7165#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7166#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007167 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007168
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007169 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007170 case Type::LValueReference:
7171 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007172 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007173 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007174
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007175 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007176 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7177 case Type::VariableArray:
7178 case Type::FunctionProto:
7179 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007180 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007181
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007182 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007183 {
7184 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007185 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7186 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007187 if (Unqualified) {
7188 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7189 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7190 }
7191 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7192 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007193 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007194 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007195 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007196 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007197 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007198 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7199 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007200 case Type::BlockPointer:
7201 {
7202 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007203 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7204 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007205 if (Unqualified) {
7206 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7207 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7208 }
7209 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7210 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007211 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7212 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7213 return LHS;
7214 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7215 return RHS;
7216 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7217 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007218 case Type::Atomic:
7219 {
7220 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7221 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7222 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7223 if (Unqualified) {
7224 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7225 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7226 }
7227 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7228 Unqualified);
7229 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7230 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7231 return LHS;
7232 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7233 return RHS;
7234 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7235 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007236 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007237 {
7238 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7239 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7240 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7241 return QualType();
7242
7243 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7244 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007245 if (Unqualified) {
7246 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7247 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7248 }
7249
7250 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007251 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007252 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7253 return LHS;
7254 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7255 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007256 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7257 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7258 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7259 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007260 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7261 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007262 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7263 return LHS;
7264 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7265 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007266 if (LVAT) {
7267 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7268 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7269 // has to be different.
7270 return LHS;
7271 }
7272 if (RVAT) {
7273 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7274 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7275 // has to be different.
7276 return RHS;
7277 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007278 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7279 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007280 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7281 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007282 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007283 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007284 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007285 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007286 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007287 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007288 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007289 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007290 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007291 case Type::Complex:
7292 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7293 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007294 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007295 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007296 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7297 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007298 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007299 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007300 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7301 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007302 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7303 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007304 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7305 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7306 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007307 return LHS;
7308
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007309 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007310 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007311 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007312 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7313 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7314 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007315 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7316 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007317 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007318 return QualType();
7319 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007320 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7321 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007322 return LHS;
7323
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007324 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007325 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007326 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007327
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007328 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007329}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007330
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007331bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7332 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7333 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007334 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams() !=
7335 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams())
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007336 return false;
7337 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7338 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7339 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7340 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00007341 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters && ToEPI.ConsumedParameters)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007342 for (unsigned i = 0, n = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); i != n; ++i) {
7343 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters[i] != ToEPI.ConsumedParameters[i])
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007344 return false;
7345 }
7346 return true;
7347}
7348
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007349/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7350/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7351/// return types.
7352QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7353 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7354 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7355 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7356 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7357 return LHS;
7358 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7359 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7360 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007361 QualType OldReturnType =
7362 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007363 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007364 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007365 QualType ResReturnType =
7366 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7367 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7368 return QualType();
7369 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7370 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7371 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7372 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7373 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007374 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7375 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007376 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007377 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007378 return ResultType;
7379 }
7380 }
7381 return QualType();
7382 }
7383
7384 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7385 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7386 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7387 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7388 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7389 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7390 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7391 return QualType();
7392
7393 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7394 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7395 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7396 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7397 // qualified __strong.
7398 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7399 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7400 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7401
7402 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7403 return QualType();
7404
7405 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7406 return LHS;
7407 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7408 return RHS;
7409 return QualType();
7410 }
7411
7412 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7413 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7414 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7415 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7416 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7417 return LHS;
7418 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7419 return RHS;
7420 }
7421 return QualType();
7422}
7423
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00007424//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007425// Integer Predicates
7426//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00007427
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007428unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00007429 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00007430 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00007431 if (T->isBooleanType())
7432 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00007433 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007434 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7435}
7436
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00007437QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00007438 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007439
7440 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7441 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7442 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007443 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007444
7445 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7446 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007447 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007448
7449 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7450 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007451 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7452 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7453 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7454 return UnsignedCharTy;
7455 case BuiltinType::Short:
7456 return UnsignedShortTy;
7457 case BuiltinType::Int:
7458 return UnsignedIntTy;
7459 case BuiltinType::Long:
7460 return UnsignedLongTy;
7461 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7462 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00007463 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7464 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007465 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007466 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007467 }
7468}
7469
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00007470ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7471
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00007472void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7473 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007474
7475//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7476// Builtin Type Computation
7477//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7478
7479/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007480/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
7481/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7482/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7483/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007484///
7485/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7486/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007487static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007488 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007489 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007490 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007491 // Modifiers.
7492 int HowLong = 0;
7493 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007494 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007495
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007496 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007497 bool Done = false;
7498 while (!Done) {
7499 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007500 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007501 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007502 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007503 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007504 case 'S':
7505 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7506 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7507 Signed = true;
7508 break;
7509 case 'U':
7510 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7511 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7512 Unsigned = true;
7513 break;
7514 case 'L':
7515 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7516 ++HowLong;
7517 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00007518 case 'W':
7519 // This modifier represents int64 type.
7520 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
7521 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
7522 default:
7523 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
7524 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
7525 HowLong = 1;
7526 break;
7527 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
7528 HowLong = 2;
7529 break;
7530 }
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007531 }
7532 }
7533
7534 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007535
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007536 // Read the base type.
7537 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007538 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007539 case 'v':
7540 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7541 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7542 Type = Context.VoidTy;
7543 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00007544 case 'h':
7545 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7546 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7547 Type = Context.HalfTy;
7548 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007549 case 'f':
7550 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7551 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7552 Type = Context.FloatTy;
7553 break;
7554 case 'd':
7555 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7556 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7557 if (HowLong)
7558 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7559 else
7560 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7561 break;
7562 case 's':
7563 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7564 if (Unsigned)
7565 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
7566 else
7567 Type = Context.ShortTy;
7568 break;
7569 case 'i':
7570 if (HowLong == 3)
7571 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
7572 else if (HowLong == 2)
7573 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
7574 else if (HowLong == 1)
7575 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
7576 else
7577 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
7578 break;
7579 case 'c':
7580 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
7581 if (Signed)
7582 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
7583 else if (Unsigned)
7584 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
7585 else
7586 Type = Context.CharTy;
7587 break;
7588 case 'b': // boolean
7589 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
7590 Type = Context.BoolTy;
7591 break;
7592 case 'z': // size_t.
7593 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
7594 Type = Context.getSizeType();
7595 break;
7596 case 'F':
7597 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
7598 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00007599 case 'G':
7600 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
7601 break;
7602 case 'H':
7603 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
7604 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00007605 case 'M':
7606 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
7607 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007608 case 'a':
7609 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7610 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7611 break;
7612 case 'A':
7613 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
7614 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
7615 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
7616 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
7617 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
7618 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
7619 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
7620 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
7621 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7622 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007623 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007624 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007625 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007626 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007627 break;
7628 case 'V': {
7629 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007630 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7631 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007632 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007633
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007634 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
7635 RequiresICE, false);
7636 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007637
7638 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00007639 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007640 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007641 break;
7642 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00007643 case 'E': {
7644 char *End;
7645
7646 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7647 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
7648
7649 Str = End;
7650
7651 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7652 false);
7653 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
7654 break;
7655 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007656 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007657 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7658 false);
7659 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007660 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
7661 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00007662 }
7663 case 'Y' : {
7664 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
7665 break;
7666 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007667 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00007668 Type = Context.getFILEType();
7669 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007670 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007671 return QualType();
7672 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007673 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007674 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007675 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007676 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007677 else
7678 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
7679
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007680 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007681 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007682 return QualType();
7683 }
7684 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00007685 case 'K':
7686 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
7687 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
7688
7689 if (Type.isNull()) {
7690 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
7691 return QualType();
7692 }
7693 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00007694 case 'p':
7695 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
7696 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007697 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007698
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007699 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
7700 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007701 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00007702 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007703 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7704 case '*':
7705 case '&': {
7706 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
7707 // qualified with an address space.
7708 char *End;
7709 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7710 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
7711 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
7712 Str = End;
7713 }
7714 if (c == '*')
7715 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
7716 else
7717 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
7718 break;
7719 }
7720 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
7721 case 'C':
7722 Type = Type.withConst();
7723 break;
7724 case 'D':
7725 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
7726 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00007727 case 'R':
7728 Type = Type.withRestrict();
7729 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007730 }
7731 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007732
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007733 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007734 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007735
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007736 return Type;
7737}
7738
7739/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007740QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007741 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007742 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007743 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.GetTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007744
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007745 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007746
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007747 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007748 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007749 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
7750 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007751 if (Error != GE_None)
7752 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007753
7754 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
7755
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007756 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007757 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007758 if (Error != GE_None)
7759 return QualType();
7760
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007761 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
7762 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
7763 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
7764 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
7765
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007766 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
7767 if (Ty->isArrayType())
7768 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007769
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007770 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
7771 }
7772
7773 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
7774 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
7775
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007776 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007777 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
7778
7779 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
7780
7781 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
7782 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
7783 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00007784
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007785 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007786 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
7787 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007788
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007789 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007790}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00007791
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007792GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007793 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007794 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007795
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007796 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7797 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
7798 case TSK_Undeclared:
7799 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7800 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7801 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007802
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007803 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
7804 return GVA_ExplicitTemplateInstantiation;
7805
7806 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7807 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
7808 External = GVA_TemplateInstantiation;
7809 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007810 }
7811
7812 if (!FD->isInlined())
7813 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007814
Alp Tokerbfa39342014-01-14 12:51:41 +00007815 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007816 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007817 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
7818 // externally visible.
7819 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
7820 return External;
7821
7822 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
7823 return GVA_C99Inline;
7824 }
7825
7826 // C++0x [temp.explicit]p9:
7827 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
7828 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
7829 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
7830 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
7831 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
7832 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
7833 == TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration)
7834 return GVA_C99Inline;
7835
7836 return GVA_CXXInline;
7837}
7838
7839GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007840 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
7841 return GVA_Internal;
7842
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00007843 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007844 case TSK_Undeclared:
7845 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7846 return GVA_StrongExternal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007847
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007848 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7849 llvm_unreachable("Variable should not be instantiated");
7850 // Fall through to treat this like any other instantiation.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007851
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007852 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
7853 return GVA_ExplicitTemplateInstantiation;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007854
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007855 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
7856 return GVA_TemplateInstantiation;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007857 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00007858
7859 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007860}
7861
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00007862bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007863 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
7864 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
7865 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00007866 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7867 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
7868 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
7869 return false;
7870 } else
7871 return false;
7872
7873 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
7874 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007875 return false;
7876
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007877 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
7878 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
7879 return false;
7880
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007881 // Aliases and used decls are required.
7882 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
7883 return true;
7884
7885 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7886 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00007887 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00007888 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007889
7890 // Constructors and destructors are required.
7891 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
7892 return true;
7893
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00007894 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
7895 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
7896 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
7897 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
7898 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
7899 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
7900 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
7901 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
7902 return true;
7903 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007904 }
7905 }
7906
7907 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
7908
7909 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
7910 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
7911 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
7912 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_C99Inline ||
Anton Yartsev79de4d42012-02-02 06:06:34 +00007913 Linkage == GVA_CXXInline || Linkage == GVA_TemplateInstantiation)
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007914 return false;
7915 return true;
7916 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00007917
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007918 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
7919 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
7920
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007921 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly)
7922 return false;
7923
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007924 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007925 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007926 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_TemplateInstantiation)
7927 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007928
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007929 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
7930 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
7931 return true;
7932
7933 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
7934 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this))
7935 return true;
7936
7937 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007938}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00007939
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007940CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
7941 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007942 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007943 if (IsCXXMethod)
7944 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00007945
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007946 return (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) ? CC_X86StdCall : CC_C;
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007947}
7948
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007949bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00007950 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
7951 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
7952}
7953
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00007954VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
7955 if (!VTContext.get()) {
7956 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
7957 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
7958 else
7959 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
7960 }
7961 return VTContext.get();
7962}
7963
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007964MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007965 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00007966 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007967 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
7968 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
7969 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00007970 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007971 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00007972 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007973 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007974 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007975}
7976
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00007977CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00007978
7979size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00007980 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
7981 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
7982 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
7983 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
7984 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
7985 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
7986 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
7987 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
7988 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
7989 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
7990 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
7991 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
7992 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
7993 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00007994}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00007995
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00007996/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
7997/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
7998/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
7999/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8000QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8001 unsigned Signed) const {
8002 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8003 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8004 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8005 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8006 return QualTy;
8007}
8008
8009/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8010/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8011/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8012QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8013 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8014 switch (Ty) {
8015 case TargetInfo::Float:
8016 return FloatTy;
8017 case TargetInfo::Double:
8018 return DoubleTy;
8019 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8020 return LongDoubleTy;
8021 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8022 return QualType();
8023 }
8024
8025 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8026}
8027
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008028void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8029 if (Number > 1)
8030 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008031}
8032
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008033unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8034 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8035 MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8036 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008037}
8038
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00008039void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8040 if (Number > 1)
8041 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8042}
8043
8044unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8045 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8046 StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
8047 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8048}
8049
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008050MangleNumberingContext &
8051ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00008052 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8053 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8054 if (!MCtx)
8055 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8056 return *MCtx;
8057}
8058
8059MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8060 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008061}
8062
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008063void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8064 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8065}
8066
8067unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8068 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8069 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8070 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8071 return I->second;
8072}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008073
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008074APValue *
8075ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8076 bool MayCreate) {
8077 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8078 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
8079 if (MayCreate)
8080 return &MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8081
8082 llvm::DenseMap<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue>::iterator I =
8083 MaterializedTemporaryValues.find(E);
8084 return I == MaterializedTemporaryValues.end() ? 0 : &I->second;
8085}
8086
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008087bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8088 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8089 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8090 return false;
8091
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00008092 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8093 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8094 return false;
8095
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008096 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8097 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8098 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8099 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8100 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8101 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8102 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8103}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008104
8105namespace {
8106
8107 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8108 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8109 ///
8110 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8111 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8112 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8113 ///
8114 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
8115 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
8116
8117 public:
8118 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8119 ///
8120 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
8121 static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8122 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap);
8123 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
8124 return Visitor.Parents;
8125 }
8126
8127 private:
8128 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8129
8130 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) {
8131 }
8132
8133 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8134 return true;
8135 }
8136 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8137 return true;
8138 }
8139 // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which
8140 // are not triggered during data recursion.
8141 bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const {
8142 return false;
8143 }
8144
8145 template <typename T>
8146 bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) {
8147 if (Node == NULL)
8148 return true;
8149 if (ParentStack.size() > 0)
8150 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, for example
8151 // when we visit all subexpressions of template instantiations; this is
8152 // suboptimal, bug benign: the only way to visit those is with
8153 // hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create new matches.
8154 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8155 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8156 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8157 // do not have pointer identity.
8158 (*Parents)[Node].push_back(ParentStack.back());
8159 ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node));
8160 bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node);
8161 ParentStack.pop_back();
8162 return Result;
8163 }
8164
8165 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
8166 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl);
8167 }
8168
8169 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
8170 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt);
8171 }
8172
8173 ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents;
8174 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8175
8176 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8177 };
8178
8179} // end namespace
8180
8181ASTContext::ParentVector
8182ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8183 assert(Node.getMemoizationData() &&
8184 "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be "
8185 "used in the parent map.");
8186 if (!AllParents) {
8187 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8188 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8189 AllParents.reset(
8190 ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl()));
8191 }
8192 ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData());
8193 if (I == AllParents->end()) {
8194 return ParentVector();
8195 }
8196 return I->second;
8197}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008198
8199bool
8200ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8201 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8202 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8203 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8204 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8205 return false;
8206 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8207 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8208 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008209 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008210 return false;
8211
8212 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8213 return false;
8214
8215 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8216 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8217 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8218 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8219 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8220 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8221 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8222 return false;
8223 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8224 return false;
8225 }
8226 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8227
8228}